blob: 3c245abada966222589cf66bb5164de42292a130 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02007 2014/04/23
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
451 - gid
452 - group
453 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100454 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - nbproc
456 - pidfile
457 - uid
458 - ulimit-n
459 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200460 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100461 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200462 - node
463 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100464 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200466 * Performance tuning
467 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200468 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100469 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100470 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100471 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200472 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200473 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200474 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200475 - noepoll
476 - nokqueue
477 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100478 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300479 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200480 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200481 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200482 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100483 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100484 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200485 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100486 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100487 - tune.maxaccept
488 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200489 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200490 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100491 - tune.rcvbuf.client
492 - tune.rcvbuf.server
493 - tune.sndbuf.client
494 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100495 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100496 - tune.ssl.lifetime
497 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100498 - tune.zlib.memlevel
499 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100500
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200501 * Debugging
502 - debug
503 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200504
505
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005063.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200507------------------------------------
508
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200509ca-base <dir>
510 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200511 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
512 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200513
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200514chroot <jail dir>
515 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
516 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
517 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
518 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
519 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
520 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100521
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100522cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
523 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
524 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
525 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
526 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32,
527 and any process IDs above nbproc are ignored. It is possible to specify all
528 processes at once using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers
529 using "even", just like with the "bind-process" directive. The second and
530 forthcoming arguments are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number
531 between 0 and 31 or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-').
532 Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes will be
533 allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may
534 be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when
535 they overlap.
536
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200537crt-base <dir>
538 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
539 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
540 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
541
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200542daemon
543 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
544 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
545 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
546
547gid <number>
548 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
549 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
550 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100551 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
552 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200553 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100554
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200555group <group name>
556 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
557 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100558
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200559log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
561 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100562 configured with "log global".
563
564 <address> can be one of:
565
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100566 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100567 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
568 port).
569
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100570 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
571 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
572 port).
573
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100574 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
575 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
576 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
577 writeable).
578
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100579 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
580 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
581 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
582 in Bourne shell.
583
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100584 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200585
586 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
587 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
588 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
589
590 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200591 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
592 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
593 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
594 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
595 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
596 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200598 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200599
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100600log-send-hostname [<string>]
601 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
602 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
603 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
604 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
605 the logs.
606
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000607log-tag <string>
608 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
609 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
610 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
611 running on the same host.
612
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200613nbproc <number>
614 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
615 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
616 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
617 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
618 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
619
620pidfile <pidfile>
621 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
622 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
623 starting the process. See also "daemon".
624
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +0100625stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200626 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
627 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
628 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
629 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
630 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
631 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
632 the number of processes used.
633
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100634ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
635 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
636 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300637 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100638 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
639 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
640 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
641 "bind" keyword for more information.
642
643ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
644 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
645 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300646 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100647 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
648 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
649 information.
650
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100651ssl-server-verify [none|required]
652 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
653 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
654 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
655
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200656stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
657 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
658 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
659 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
660 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200661
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200662 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
663 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
664 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200665
666stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
667 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
668 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100669 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200670
671stats maxconn <connections>
672 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
673 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
674
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200675uid <number>
676 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
677 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
678 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
679 one. See also "gid" and "user".
680
681ulimit-n <number>
682 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
683 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
684 option.
685
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100686unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
687 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
688
689 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
690 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
691 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
692 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
693 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
694 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
695 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
696 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
697 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
698 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
699
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200700user <user name>
701 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
702 See also "uid" and "group".
703
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200704node <name>
705 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
706
707 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
708 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
709 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
710 traffic.
711
712description <text>
713 Add a text that describes the instance.
714
715 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
716 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
717 "<" and ">" characters.
718
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200719
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007203.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200721-----------------------
722
723maxconn <number>
724 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
725 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
726 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
727 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
728
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200729maxconnrate <number>
730 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
731 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
732 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
733 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
734 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
735 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
736 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
737 fairness.
738
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100739maxcomprate <number>
740 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300741 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100742 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
743 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
744 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
745 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
746 default value.
747
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100748maxcompcpuusage <number>
749 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
750 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
751 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
752 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
753 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
754 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
755 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
756 process down and from introducing high latencies.
757
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100758maxpipes <number>
759 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
760 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
761 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
762 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
763 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
764 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
765
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200766maxsessrate <number>
767 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
768 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
769 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
770 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
771 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
772 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
773 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
774 fairness.
775
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200776maxsslconn <number>
777 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
778 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
779 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
780 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
781 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
782 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
783 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
784
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200785maxsslrate <number>
786 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
787 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
788 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
789 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
790 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
791 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
792 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
793 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
794 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
795 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
796
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100797maxzlibmem <number>
798 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
799 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
800 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100801 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
802 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
803 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
804
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200805noepoll
806 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
807 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100808 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200809
810nokqueue
811 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
812 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
813 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
814
815nopoll
816 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
817 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100818 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100819 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100821nosplice
822 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
823 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
824 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100825 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100826 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
827 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
828 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
829 "option splice-response".
830
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300831nogetaddrinfo
832 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
833 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
834
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200835spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900836 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
837 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
838 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
839 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
840 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
841 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200842
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200843tune.bufsize <number>
844 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
845 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
846 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
847 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
848 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
849 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
850 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
851 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400852 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
853 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
854 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200855
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200856tune.chksize <number>
857 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
858 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
859 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
860 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
861 checks whenever possible.
862
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100863tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
864 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
865 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
866 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
867 this value. The default value is 1.
868
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100869tune.http.cookielen <number>
870 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
871 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
872 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
873 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
874 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
875 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
876 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
877 to change this value.
878
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200879tune.http.maxhdr <number>
880 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
881 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
882 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
883 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
884 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
885 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
886 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
887 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
888 limit too high.
889
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100890tune.idletimer <timeout>
891 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
892 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
893 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
894 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
895 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
896 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
897 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
898 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
899 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
900
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100901tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100902 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
903 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
904 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
905 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
906 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
907 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
908 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
909 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
910 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
911 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100912
913tune.maxpollevents <number>
914 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
915 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
916 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
917 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
918 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
919
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200920tune.maxrewrite <number>
921 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
922 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
923 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
924 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
925 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
926 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
927 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
928 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
929 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
930 bufsize.
931
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200932tune.pipesize <number>
933 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
934 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
935 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
936 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
937 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
938 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
939
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100940tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
941tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
942 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
943 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
944 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
945 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
946 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
947 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
948 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
949
950tune.sndbuf.client <number>
951tune.sndbuf.server <number>
952 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
953 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
954 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
955 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
956 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
957 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
958 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
959 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
960 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
961 notifying haproxy again.
962
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100963tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100964 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
965 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
966 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300967 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100968 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
969 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
970 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
971 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
972 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100973 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
974 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100975
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100976tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
977 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300978 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100979 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
980 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
981 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
982 being used for too long.
983
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100984tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
985 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
986 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
987 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
988 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
989 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
990 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
991 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
992 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
993 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
994 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100995 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
996 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100997
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100998tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
999 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001000 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001001 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1002 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1003 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1004
1005tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1006 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1007 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1008 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1009 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001010
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010113.3. Debugging
1012--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001013
1014debug
1015 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1016 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1017 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1018 system startup.
1019
1020quiet
1021 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1022 line argument "-q".
1023
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001024
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010253.4. Userlists
1026--------------
1027It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1028http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1029it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1030
1031userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001032 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001033 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1034
1035group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001036 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001037 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1038 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1039
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001040user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1041 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001042 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1043 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001044 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1045 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001046 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001047 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001048
1049
1050 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001051 userlist L1
1052 group G1 users tiger,scott
1053 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001054
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001055 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1056 user scott insecure-password elgato
1057 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001058
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001059 userlist L2
1060 group G1
1061 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001062
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001063 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1064 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1065 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001066
1067 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001068
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001069
10703.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001071----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001072It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1073haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1074pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1075identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1076or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1077Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1078known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1079the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1080process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1081during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1082tables.
1083
1084peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001085 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001086 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1087
1088peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1089 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1090 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1091 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1092 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1093 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1094 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1095
1096 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1097 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1098
1099 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1100 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1101 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1102 across all peers.
1103
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001104 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1105 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1106 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1107
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001108 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001109 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001110 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1111 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1112 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001113
1114 backend mybackend
1115 mode tcp
1116 balance roundrobin
1117 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1118 stick on src
1119
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001120 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1121 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001122
1123
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011244. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001125----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001126
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001127Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1128 - defaults <name>
1129 - frontend <name>
1130 - backend <name>
1131 - listen <name>
1132
1133A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1134its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1135section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001136section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001137
1138A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1139connections.
1140
1141A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1142to forward incoming connections.
1143
1144A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1145parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1146
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001147All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1148'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1149case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1150
1151Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1152logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1153proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1154However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1155name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1156
1157Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1158and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001159bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001160protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1161modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1162arbitrary criteria.
1163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001164In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1165a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1166the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1167
1168 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1169 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1170 between responses and new requests.
1171
1172 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1173 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1174 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1175 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1176
1177 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1178 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1179 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1180
1181 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1182 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1183 client-facing connection remains open.
1184
1185 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1186 after the end of the response.
1187
1188The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1189frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1190following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1191weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1192
1193 Backend mode
1194
1195 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1196 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1197 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1198 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1199 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1200 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1201 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1202 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1203 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1204 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1205 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1206
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001207
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012094.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1210--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001212The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1213limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1214they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1215limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001216marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001217option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001218and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1219with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1220specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001221
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001222
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001223 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1224------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1225acl - X X X
1226appsession - - X X
1227backlog X X X -
1228balance X - X X
1229bind - X X -
1230bind-process X X X X
1231block - X X X
1232capture cookie - X X -
1233capture request header - X X -
1234capture response header - X X -
1235clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001236compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001237contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1238cookie X - X X
1239default-server X - X X
1240default_backend X X X -
1241description - X X X
1242disabled X X X X
1243dispatch - - X X
1244enabled X X X X
1245errorfile X X X X
1246errorloc X X X X
1247errorloc302 X X X X
1248-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1249errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001250force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001251fullconn X - X X
1252grace X X X X
1253hash-type X - X X
1254http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001255http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001256http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001257http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001258http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann69e273f2013-12-11 00:52:19 +01001259tcp-check connect - - X X
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02001260tcp-check expect - - X X
1261tcp-check send - - X X
1262tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001263http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001264id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001265ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001266log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001267maxconn X X X -
1268mode X X X X
1269monitor fail - X X -
1270monitor-net X X X -
1271monitor-uri X X X -
1272option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1273option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1274option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1275option allbackups (*) X - X X
1276option checkcache (*) X - X X
1277option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1278option contstats (*) X X X -
1279option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1280option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1281option forceclose (*) X X X X
1282-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1283option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001284option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001285option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001286option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001287option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001288option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001289option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1290option httpchk X - X X
1291option httpclose (*) X X X X
1292option httplog X X X X
1293option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001294option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001295option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001296option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1297option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1298option logasap (*) X X X -
1299option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001300option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001301option nolinger (*) X X X X
1302option originalto X X X X
1303option persist (*) X - X X
1304option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001305option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001306option smtpchk X - X X
1307option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1308option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1309option splice-request (*) X X X X
1310option splice-response (*) X X X X
1311option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1312option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1313-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001314option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001315option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1316option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1317option tcpka X X X X
1318option tcplog X X X X
1319option transparent (*) X - X X
1320persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1321rate-limit sessions X X X -
1322redirect - X X X
1323redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1324redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1325reqadd - X X X
1326reqallow - X X X
1327reqdel - X X X
1328reqdeny - X X X
1329reqiallow - X X X
1330reqidel - X X X
1331reqideny - X X X
1332reqipass - X X X
1333reqirep - X X X
1334reqisetbe - X X X
1335reqitarpit - X X X
1336reqpass - X X X
1337reqrep - X X X
1338-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1339reqsetbe - X X X
1340reqtarpit - X X X
1341retries X - X X
1342rspadd - X X X
1343rspdel - X X X
1344rspdeny - X X X
1345rspidel - X X X
1346rspideny - X X X
1347rspirep - X X X
1348rsprep - X X X
1349server - - X X
1350source X - X X
1351srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001352stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001353stats auth X - X X
1354stats enable X - X X
1355stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001356stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001357stats realm X - X X
1358stats refresh X - X X
1359stats scope X - X X
1360stats show-desc X - X X
1361stats show-legends X - X X
1362stats show-node X - X X
1363stats uri X - X X
1364-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1365stick match - - X X
1366stick on - - X X
1367stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001368stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001369stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001370tcp-request connection - X X -
1371tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001372tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001373tcp-response content - - X X
1374tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001375timeout check X - X X
1376timeout client X X X -
1377timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1378timeout connect X - X X
1379timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1380timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1381timeout http-request X X X X
1382timeout queue X - X X
1383timeout server X - X X
1384timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1385timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001386timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001387transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001388unique-id-format X X X -
1389unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001390use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001391use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001392------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1393 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001394
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001395
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013964.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1397---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001398
1399This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1400
1401
1402acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1403 Declare or complete an access list.
1404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1405 no | yes | yes | yes
1406 Example:
1407 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1408 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1409 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1410
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001411 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001412
1413
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001414appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1415 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001416 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1418 no | no | yes | yes
1419 Arguments :
1420 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1421 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1422
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001423 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001424 checked in each cookie value.
1425
1426 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1427 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1428 milliseconds.
1429
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001430 request-learn
1431 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1432 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1433 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1434 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1435 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1436 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1437
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001438 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1439 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1440 data following this prefix.
1441
1442 Example :
1443 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1444
1445 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1446 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1447
1448 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1449 2 modes are currently supported :
1450 - path-parameters :
1451 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1452 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1453 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1454 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1455 - query-string :
1456 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1457 query string.
1458
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001459 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1460 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1461 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1462 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001463 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1464 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1465 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001466 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1467 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1468
1469 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1470
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001471 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1472 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1473 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1474
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001475 Example :
1476 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1477
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001478 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1479 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001480
1481
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001482backlog <conns>
1483 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1485 yes | yes | yes | no
1486 Arguments :
1487 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1488 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001489 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001490
1491 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1492 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1493 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1494 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1495 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1496 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1497 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1498 backlog parameter.
1499
1500 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1501 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1502 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1503
1504 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1505
1506
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001507balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001508balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001509 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1511 yes | no | yes | yes
1512 Arguments :
1513 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1514 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1515 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1516 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1517
1518 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1519 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1520 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1521 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001522 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001523 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001524 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1525 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1526 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1527 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1528 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1529 it, so that you don't worry.
1530
1531 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1532 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1533 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1534 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1535 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1536 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1537 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1538 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001539
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001540 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1541 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1542 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1543 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1544 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1545 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1546 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1547 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1548
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001549 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001550 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001551 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1552 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001553 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001554 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1555 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1556 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1557 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1558 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001559 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1560 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1561 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1562 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1563 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1564 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001565
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001566 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1567 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1568 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1569 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1570 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1571 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1572 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1573 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001574 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001575 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001576 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1577 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1578 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001579
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001580 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1581 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1582 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1583 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1584 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1585 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1586 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1587 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1588 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1589 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1590 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1591 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001592
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001593 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001594 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1595 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1596 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1597 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1598 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1599 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1600 URIs start with a leading "/".
1601
1602 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1603 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1604 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1605 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1606
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001607 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001608 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1609
1610 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001611 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1612 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001613 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1614 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1615 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1616 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001617 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001618 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1619 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001620
1621 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1622 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1623 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1624 server will receive the request.
1625
1626 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1627 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1628 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1629 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1630 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001631 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1632 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1633 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001634
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001635 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1636 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1637 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1638 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1639 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001640
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001641 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001642 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1643 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1644 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1645
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001646 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1647 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1648 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1649
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001650 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001651 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001652 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1653 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1654 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1655 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1656 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1657 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001658 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001659 used instead.
1660
1661 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1662 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1663 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1664 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1665
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001666 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1667 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1668 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1669
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001670 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001671
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001672 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001673 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1674 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001675
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001676 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1677 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1678 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001679
1680 Examples :
1681 balance roundrobin
1682 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001683 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001684 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1685 balance hdr(host)
1686 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001687
1688 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1689 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1690
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001691 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001692 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1693 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1694 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1695 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1696
1697 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1698 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1699 defaults to 16 kB.
1700
1701 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1702 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1703
1704 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1705 Round Robin.
1706
1707 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1708 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1709 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1710 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1711
1712 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1713
1714 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001715 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001716 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1717 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1718 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001719
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001720 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1721 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001722
1723
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001724bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1725bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001726 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1728 no | yes | yes | no
1729 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001730 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1731 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1732 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1733 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001734 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001735 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1736 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1737 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1738 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1739 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1740 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1741 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001742 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1743 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1744 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001745 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1746 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1747 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1748 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001749
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001750 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1751 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001752 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1753 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1754 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001755 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1756 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1757 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1758 the range.
1759
1760 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1761 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1762 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1763 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1764 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1765 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1766 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001767 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001768 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001769
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001770 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1771 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1772 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1773 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1774 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1775 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1776 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1777 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1778
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001779 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1780 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1781 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1782 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001783
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001784 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1785 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1786 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1787 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1788 in a frontend.
1789
1790 Example :
1791 listen http_proxy
1792 bind :80,:443
1793 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001794 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001795
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001796 listen http_https_proxy
1797 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001798 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001799
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001800 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1801 bind ipv6@:80
1802 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1803 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1804
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001805 listen external_bind_app1
1806 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1807
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001808 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001809 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001810
1811
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001812bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32>[-<number 1-32>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001813 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1815 yes | yes | yes | yes
1816 Arguments :
1817 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1818 may be used to override a default value.
1819
1820 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1821 option may be combined with other numbers.
1822
1823 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1824 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1825 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1826 missing from all processes.
1827
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001828 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
1829 whose values must all be between 1 and 32. You must be
1830 careful not to reference a process number greater than the
1831 configured global.nbproc, otherwise some instances might be
1832 missing from all processes.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001833
1834 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1835 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1836 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1837 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1838 and 'even' instances.
1839
1840 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1841 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1842 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1843 32.
1844
1845 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1846 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1847
1848 Example :
1849 listen app_ip1
1850 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001851 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001852
1853 listen app_ip2
1854 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001855 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001856
1857 listen management
1858 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001859 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001860
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001861 listen management
1862 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1863 bind-process 1-4
1864
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001865 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1866
1867
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001868block { if | unless } <condition>
1869 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1871 no | yes | yes | yes
1872
1873 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1874 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001875 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001876 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001877 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1878 "block" statements per instance.
1879
1880 Example:
1881 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1882 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1883 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1884 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1885
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001886 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001887
1888
1889capture cookie <name> len <length>
1890 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1892 no | yes | yes | no
1893 Arguments :
1894 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1895 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1896 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1897 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1898 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1899
1900 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1901 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1902 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1903 right if it exceeds <length>.
1904
1905 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1906 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1907 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1908 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1909
1910 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1911 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1912 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1913
1914 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1915 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1916 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001917 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1918 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1919 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001920
1921 Example:
1922 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1923
1924 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001925 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001926
1927
1928capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001929 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1931 no | yes | yes | no
1932 Arguments :
1933 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001934 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001935 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1936 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1937 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1938
1939 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1940 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1941 it exceeds <length>.
1942
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001943 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001944 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1945 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001946 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1947 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1948 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1949 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001950 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001951 environments to find where the request came from.
1952
1953 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1954 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1955 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1956 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001957
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001958 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1959 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1960 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1961 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1962 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001963
1964 Example:
1965 capture request header Host len 15
1966 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1967 capture request header Referrer len 15
1968
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001969 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001970 about logging.
1971
1972
1973capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001974 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1976 no | yes | yes | no
1977 Arguments :
1978 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001979 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001980 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1981 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1982 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1983
1984 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1985 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1986 it exceeds <length>.
1987
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001988 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001989 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1990 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1991 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001992 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1993 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1994 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1995 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001996
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001997 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
1998 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1999 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2000 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2001 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002002
2003 Example:
2004 capture response header Content-length len 9
2005 capture response header Location len 15
2006
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002007 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002008 about logging.
2009
2010
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002011clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002012 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2014 yes | yes | yes | no
2015 Arguments :
2016 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2017 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2018 as explained at the top of this document.
2019
2020 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2021 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2022 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2023 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2024 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2025 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2026 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2027 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002028 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002029 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2030 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2031
2032 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2033 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2034 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2035 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2036 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2037 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2038
2039 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2040 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2041
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002042 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2043 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002044
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002045compression algo <algorithm> ...
2046compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002047compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002048 Enable HTTP compression.
2049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2050 yes | yes | yes | yes
2051 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002052 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2053 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2054 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2055
2056 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002057 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002058 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2059 data.
2060
2061 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2062 support for zlib was built in.
2063
2064 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2065 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2066 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2067 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2068 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2069 in.
2070
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002071 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002072 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002073 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2074 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2075 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2076 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2077 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002078
2079 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2080 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2081 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2082 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2083 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002084 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2085 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2086 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2087 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2088 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
2089 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002090
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002091 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002092 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2093 "Accept-Encoding" header
2094 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002095 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002096 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2097 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002098 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2099 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2100 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2101 "multipart"
2102 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2103 header
2104 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2105 and later
2106 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2107 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002108
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002109 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2110 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002111
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002112 Examples :
2113 compression algo gzip
2114 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002115
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002116contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002117 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2119 yes | no | yes | yes
2120 Arguments :
2121 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2122 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2123 as explained at the top of this document.
2124
2125 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002126 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002127 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002128 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2129 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2130 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2131 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2132
2133 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2134 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2135 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2136 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2137 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2138 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2139
2140 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2141 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2142 instead.
2143
2144 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2145 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2146
2147
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002148cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002149 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2150 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002151 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2153 yes | no | yes | yes
2154 Arguments :
2155 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2156 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2157 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2158 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2159 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2160 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2161 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2162 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2163 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2164
2165 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2166 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2167 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2168 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2169 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2170 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2171 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2172 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2173 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2174 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2175 "insert" and "prefix".
2176
2177 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002178 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002179
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002180 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002181 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2182 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2183 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2184 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2185 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2186 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2187 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2188 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2189 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2190 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002191
2192 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2193 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2194 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2195 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2196 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2197 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2198 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2199 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2200 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2201 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002202 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2203 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2204 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002205
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002206 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2207 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2208 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002209 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2210 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2211 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2212 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002213 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2214 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2215 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002216
2217 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2218 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2219 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2220 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2221 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2222 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2223 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2224 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2225 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2226
2227 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2228 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2229 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2230 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2231 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2232 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2233 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2234 persistence cookie in the cache.
2235 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2236
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002237 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2238 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2239 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2240 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2241 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2242 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2243 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2244 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2245 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2246 they logout.
2247
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002248 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2249 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2250 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2251 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2252
2253 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2254 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2255 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2256 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2257 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2258 this attribute.
2259
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002260 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002261 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002262 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2263 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2264 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2265 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2266 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2267 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002268
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002269 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2270 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2271 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2272 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2273 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2274 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2275 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2276 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2277 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2278 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2279 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2280 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2281 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2282 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2283 the site.
2284
2285 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2286 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2287 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2288 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2289 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2290 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2291 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2292 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2293 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2294 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2295 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2296 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2297 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2298 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2299 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2300 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2301
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002302 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2303 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2304 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2305 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002306
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002307 Examples :
2308 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2309 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2310 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002311 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002312
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002313 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002314 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002315
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002316
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002317default-server [param*]
2318 Change default options for a server in a backend
2319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2320 yes | no | yes | yes
2321 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002322 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2323 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2324 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2325 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002326
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002327 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002328 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2329
2330 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002331
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002332
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002333default_backend <backend>
2334 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2336 yes | yes | yes | no
2337 Arguments :
2338 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2339
2340 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2341 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2342 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2343 will catch all undetermined requests.
2344
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002345 Example :
2346
2347 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2348 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2349 default_backend dynamic
2350
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002351 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2352
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002353
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002354description <string>
2355 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2357 no | yes | yes | yes
2358 Arguments : string
2359
2360 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2361 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2362 it describes.
2363 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2364
2365
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002366disabled
2367 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2369 yes | yes | yes | yes
2370 Arguments : none
2371
2372 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2373 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2374 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2375 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2376 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2377 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2378 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2379
2380 See also : "enabled"
2381
2382
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002383dispatch <address>:<port>
2384 Set a default server address
2385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2386 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002387 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002388
2389 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2390 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2391 during start-up.
2392
2393 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2394 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2395 possible with normal servers.
2396
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002397 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002398 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2399 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2400 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2401 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2402
2403 See also : "server"
2404
2405
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002406enabled
2407 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2409 yes | yes | yes | yes
2410 Arguments : none
2411
2412 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2413 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2414
2415 See also : "disabled"
2416
2417
2418errorfile <code> <file>
2419 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2421 yes | yes | yes | yes
2422 Arguments :
2423 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002424 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002425
2426 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002427 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002428 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002429 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2430 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002431
2432 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2433 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2434 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2435
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002436 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2437
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002438 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2439 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2440 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2441 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2442
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002443 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2444 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2445 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2446 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2447 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2448 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2449
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002450 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2451 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2452 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002453 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002454 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2455
2456 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2457
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002458 Example :
2459 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2460 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2461 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2462
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002463
2464errorloc <code> <url>
2465errorloc302 <code> <url>
2466 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2468 yes | yes | yes | yes
2469 Arguments :
2470 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002471 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002472
2473 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2474 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2475 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2476 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2477 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2478
2479 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2480 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2481 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2482
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002483 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2484
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002485 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2486 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2487 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2488 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2489 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2490 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2491 request.
2492
2493 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2494
2495
2496errorloc303 <code> <url>
2497 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2499 yes | yes | yes | yes
2500 Arguments :
2501 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2502 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2503
2504 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2505 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2506 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2507 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2508 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2509
2510 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2511 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2512 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2513
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002514 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2515
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002516 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2517 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2518 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2519 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002520 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002521
2522 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2523
2524
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002525force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2526 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2527 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2528 no | yes | yes | yes
2529
2530 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2531 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2532 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2533 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2534 marked down for maintenance operations.
2535
2536 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2537 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2538 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2539 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2540 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2541 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2542 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2543 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2544 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2545
2546 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2547 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2548 is used.
2549
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002550 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002551 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002552
2553
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002554fullconn <conns>
2555 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2556 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2557 yes | no | yes | yes
2558 Arguments :
2559 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2560 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2561
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002562 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002563 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002564 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002565 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2566 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2567 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2568 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2569 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002570 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002571
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002572 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2573 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002574 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2575 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2576 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002577
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002578 Example :
2579 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2580 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2581 # connections.
2582 backend dynamic
2583 fullconn 10000
2584 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2585 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2586
2587 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2588
2589
2590grace <time>
2591 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002593 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002594 Arguments :
2595 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2596 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2597 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2598
2599 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2600 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002601 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002602 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2603
2604 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2605 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2606 simplify it.
2607
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002608
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002609hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002610 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2612 yes | no | yes | yes
2613 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002614 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2615 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002616
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002617 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2618 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2619 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2620 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2621 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2622 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2623 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2624 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2625 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2626 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002627
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002628 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2629 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2630 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2631 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2632 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2633 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2634 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2635 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2636 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2637 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2638 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2639 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2640 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002641 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2642 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002643
2644 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2645
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002646 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002647 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2648 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2649 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002650 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2651 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2652 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002653
2654 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2655 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002656 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2657 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2658 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2659 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2660
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002661 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2662 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2663 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2664 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2665 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2666 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2667 parameter.
2668
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002669 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2670
2671 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2672 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2673 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2674 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2675 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2676 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2677 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2678 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2679 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2680 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2681 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2682 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002683
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002684 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2685 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2686 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002687
2688 See also : "balance", "server"
2689
2690
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002691http-check disable-on-404
2692 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002694 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002695 Arguments : none
2696
2697 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2698 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2699 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2700 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2701 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2702 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2703 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2704 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002705 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2706 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2707 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2708
2709 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2710
2711
2712http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002713 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002715 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002716 Arguments :
2717 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2718 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002719 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002720 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2721 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2722 details on the supported keywords.
2723
2724 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2725 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2726 with the usual backslash ('\').
2727
2728 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2729 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2730 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2731 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2732 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2733
2734 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002735 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002736 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2737 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2738 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2739
2740 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002741 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002742 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2743 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2744 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2745 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2746
2747 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002748 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002749 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2750 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2751 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2752 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2753 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2754 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2755 trace).
2756
2757 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002758 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002759 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2760 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2761 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2762 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2763 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2764 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2765
2766 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2767 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2768 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2769 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2770 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2771 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2772 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2773 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2774
2775 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2776 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2777
2778 Examples :
2779 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002780 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002781
2782 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002783 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002784
2785 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002786 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002787
2788 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002789 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002790
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002791 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002792
2793
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002794http-check send-state
2795 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2797 yes | no | yes | yes
2798 Arguments : none
2799
2800 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2801 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2802 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2803 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2804 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2805
2806 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2807 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2808 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2809 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2810 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2811 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2812 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2813 checked in multiple backends.
2814
2815 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2816 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2817
2818 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2819 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2820 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2821 one fails.
2822
2823 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2824 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2825 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2826
2827 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2828 server's queue.
2829
2830 Example of a header received by the application server :
2831 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2832 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2833
2834 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2835
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002836http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002837 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002838 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
2839 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002840 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002841 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2842
2843 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2844 no | yes | yes | yes
2845
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002846 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2847 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2848 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2849 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2850 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002851
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002852 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2853 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2854 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2855
2856 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2857 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2858 are evaluated.
2859
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002860 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2861 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2862 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2863 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2864 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2865 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2866 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2867 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2868 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002869 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002870 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2871
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002872 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2873 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2874 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2875 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2876 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2877
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002878 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2879 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2880 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002881 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2882 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002883
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002884 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2885 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2886 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2887 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2888 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2889 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2890 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2891 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2892
2893 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2894 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2895 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2896 external users.
2897
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002898 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2899 <name>.
2900
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002901 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2902 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2903 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2904 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2905 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2906 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2907 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2908 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2909
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002910 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2911 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2912 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2913 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2914 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2915 another equipment.
2916
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002917 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2918 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2919 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2920 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2921 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2922 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2923 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2924 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2925
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002926 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2927 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2928 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2929 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2930 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2931 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2932 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2933 admin privileges.
2934
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002935 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
2936
2937 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
2938 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
2939 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
2940 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002941
2942 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002943 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2944 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2945 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002946
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002947 http-request allow if nagios
2948 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2949 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2950 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002951
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002952 Example:
2953 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002954 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002955
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002956 Example:
2957 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
2958 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
2959 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
2960 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
2961 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
2962 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
2963 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
2964 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
2965 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
2966
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002967 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2968 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002969
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002970http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002971 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
2972 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02002973 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002974 Access control for Layer 7 responses
2975
2976 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2977 no | yes | yes | yes
2978
2979 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2980 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2981 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2982 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2983 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
2984 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
2985
2986 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2987 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
2988 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
2989 current section.
2990
2991 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2992 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
2993 rules are evaluated.
2994
2995 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2996 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2997 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
2998 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
2999 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3000 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3001 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3002
3003 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3004 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3005 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3006 external users.
3007
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003008 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3009 <name>.
3010
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003011 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3012 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3013 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3014 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3015 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3016 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3017 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3018 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3019
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003020 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3021 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3022 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3023 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3024 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3025 another equipment.
3026
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003027 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3028 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3029 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3030 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3031 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3032 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3033 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3034 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3035
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003036 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3037 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3038 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3039 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3040 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3041 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3042 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3043 admin privileges.
3044
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003045 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3046
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003047 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003048 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3049 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3050 rules.
3051
3052 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3053 ACL usage.
3054
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003055
Baptiste Assmann69e273f2013-12-11 00:52:19 +01003056tcp-check connect [params*]
3057 Opens a new connection
3058 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3059 no | no | yes | yes
3060
3061 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
3062 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
3063 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
3064
3065 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
3066 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
3067 of the sequence.
3068
3069 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
3070 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
3071 do.
3072
3073 Parameters :
3074 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
3075 use the TCP connection.
3076
3077 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
3078 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
3079 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
3080
3081 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
3082
3083 ssl opens a ciphered connection
3084
3085 Examples:
3086 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
3087 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
3088 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
3089 option tcp-check
3090 tcp-check connect
3091 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
3092 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
3093 tcp-check send \r\n
3094 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
3095 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
3096 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
3097 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
3098 tcp-check send \r\n
3099 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
3100 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
3101
3102 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
3103 option tcp-check
3104 tcp-check connect port 110
3105 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
3106 tcp-check connect port 143
3107 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
3108 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
3109
3110 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
3111
3112
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003113tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
3114 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
3115 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3116 no | no | yes | yes
3117
3118 Arguments :
3119 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3120 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
3121 binary.
3122 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
3123 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
3124 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
3125
3126 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3127 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3128 with the usual backslash ('\').
3129 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
3130 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
3131 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
3132 used upper or lower case.
3133
3134
3135 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
3136
3137 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
3138 A health check response will be considered valid if the
3139 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
3140 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3141 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3142 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
3143 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
3144 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
3145
3146 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
3147 A health check response will be considered valid if the
3148 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
3149 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3150 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
3151 expression.
3152
3153 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
3154 in the response buffer. A health check response will
3155 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
3156 this exact hexadecimal string.
3157 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
3158
3159 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3160 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3161 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3162 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
3163 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3164 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3165 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3166 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
3167 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
3168 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
3169 the null character.
3170
3171 Examples :
3172 # perform a POP check
3173 option tcp-check
3174 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
3175
3176 # perform an IMAP check
3177 option tcp-check
3178 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
3179
3180 # look for the redis master server
3181 option tcp-check
3182 tcp-check send PING\r\n
3183 tcp-check expect +PONG
3184 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
3185 tcp-check expect string role:master
3186 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
3187 tcp-check expect string +OK
3188
3189
Baptiste Assmann69e273f2013-12-11 00:52:19 +01003190 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
3191 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003192
3193
3194tcp-check send <data>
3195 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3196 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3197 no | no | yes | yes
3198
3199 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3200 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
3201
3202 Examples :
3203 # look for the redis master server
3204 option tcp-check
3205 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
3206 tcp-check expect string role:master
3207
Baptiste Assmann69e273f2013-12-11 00:52:19 +01003208 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
3209 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003210
3211
3212tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
3213 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
3214 tcp health check
3215 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3216 no | no | yes | yes
3217
3218 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
3219 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
3220 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
3221 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
3222 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
3223 hexadecimal string.
3224 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
3225
3226 Examples :
3227 # redis check in binary
3228 option tcp-check
3229 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
3230 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
3231
3232
Baptiste Assmann69e273f2013-12-11 00:52:19 +01003233 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
3234 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003235
3236
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003237http-send-name-header [<header>]
3238 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3239
3240 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3241 yes | no | yes | yes
3242
3243 Arguments :
3244
3245 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3246
3247 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3248 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3249 is added with the header string proved.
3250
3251 See also : "server"
3252
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003253id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003254 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3256 no | yes | yes | yes
3257 Arguments : none
3258
3259 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3260 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3261 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003262
3263
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003264ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3265 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3266 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3267 no | yes | yes | yes
3268
3269 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3270 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3271 and running).
3272
3273 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3274 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3275 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003276 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003277 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3278
3279 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3280 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3281
3282 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3283 "unless" condition is met.
3284
3285 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3286
3287
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003288log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003289log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003290no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003291 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3293 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003294
3295 Prefix :
3296 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3297 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3298 prefix does not allow arguments.
3299
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003300 Arguments :
3301 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3302 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3303 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3304 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3305 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3306 parameter.
3307
3308 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3309 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3310
3311 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3312 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3313 standard syslog port).
3314
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003315 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3316 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3317 standard syslog port).
3318
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003319 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3320 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3321 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3322 appropriately writeable).
3323
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003324 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3325 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3326 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3327 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3328
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003329 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3330
3331 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3332 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3333 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3334
3335 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3336 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3337 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003338 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3339 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3340 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3341 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3342 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003343
3344 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3345
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003346 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3347 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3348 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003349
3350 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3351 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3352 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3353 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3354
3355 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3356 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003357
3358 Example :
3359 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003360 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3361 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003362 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3363
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003364
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003365log-format <string>
3366 Allows you to custom a log line.
3367
3368 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3369
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003370
3371maxconn <conns>
3372 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3374 yes | yes | yes | no
3375 Arguments :
3376 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3377 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3378 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3379 closes.
3380
3381 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3382 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3383 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3384 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3385 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3386 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3387 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3388 properly tuned.
3389
3390 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3391 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3392 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3393
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003394 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3395
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003396 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3397
3398
3399mode { tcp|http|health }
3400 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3402 yes | yes | yes | yes
3403 Arguments :
3404 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3405 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3406 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3407 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3408
3409 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3410 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3411 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3412 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3413 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3414
3415 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003416 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3417 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3418 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3419 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3420 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3421 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3422 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003423
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003424 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3425 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3426 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003427
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003428 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003429 defaults http_instances
3430 mode http
3431
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003432 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003433
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003434
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003435monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003436 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3438 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003439 Arguments :
3440 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3441 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003442 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003443 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3444 backend and its backup.
3445
3446 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3447 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3448 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3449 servers in a list of backends.
3450
3451 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3452 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3453 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3454 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3455 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3456 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3457 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003458 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3459 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003460
3461 Example:
3462 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003463 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003464 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3465 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3466 monitor-uri /site_alive
3467 monitor fail if site_dead
3468
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003469 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003470
3471
3472monitor-net <source>
3473 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3475 yes | yes | yes | no
3476 Arguments :
3477 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3478 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3479 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3480 followed by a mask.
3481
3482 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3483 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003484 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003485 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3486
3487 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3488 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3489 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3490 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003491 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3492 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3493 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003494
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003495 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3496 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3497 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3498 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3499 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3500 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003501
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003502 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3503 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003504
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003505 Example :
3506 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3507 frontend www
3508 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3509
3510 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3511
3512
3513monitor-uri <uri>
3514 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3516 yes | yes | yes | no
3517 Arguments :
3518 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3519 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3520
3521 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3522 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3523 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3524 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3525 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3526 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3527 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3528 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3529
3530 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3531 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3532 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3533 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3534 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3535 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3536
3537 Example :
3538 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3539 frontend www
3540 mode http
3541 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3542
3543 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3544
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003545
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003546option abortonclose
3547no option abortonclose
3548 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3550 yes | no | yes | yes
3551 Arguments : none
3552
3553 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3554 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3555 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3556 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003557 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003558 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3559 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3560 encountered while delivering the response.
3561
3562 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3563 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3564 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3565 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3566 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3567 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003568 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003569 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003570 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003571 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3572 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3573 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3574
3575 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3576 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3577 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3578 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3579 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3580 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3581 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3582 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003583 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003584
3585 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3586 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3587
3588 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3589
3590
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003591option accept-invalid-http-request
3592no option accept-invalid-http-request
3593 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3595 yes | yes | yes | no
3596 Arguments : none
3597
3598 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3599 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3600 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3601 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3602 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3603 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3604 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3605 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003606 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3607 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3608 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3609 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3610 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3611 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003612
3613 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3614 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3615 been confirmed.
3616
3617 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3618 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003619 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3620 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003621 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3622
3623 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3624 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3625
3626 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3627 stats socket.
3628
3629
3630option accept-invalid-http-response
3631no option accept-invalid-http-response
3632 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3634 yes | no | yes | yes
3635 Arguments : none
3636
3637 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3638 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3639 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3640 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3641 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3642 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3643 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3644 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3645 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3646
3647 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3648 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3649 been confirmed.
3650
3651 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3652 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3653 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3654 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3655
3656 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3657 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3658
3659 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3660 stats socket.
3661
3662
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003663option allbackups
3664no option allbackups
3665 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3667 yes | no | yes | yes
3668 Arguments : none
3669
3670 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3671 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3672 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3673 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3674 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3675 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3676 order between the backup servers anymore.
3677
3678 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3679 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3680
3681 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3682 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3683
3684
3685option checkcache
3686no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003687 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3689 yes | no | yes | yes
3690 Arguments : none
3691
3692 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3693 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003694 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003695 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3696 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003697 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003698
3699 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003700 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003701 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003702 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3703 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003704 to the client are :
3705 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003706 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003707 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003708 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3709 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3710 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3711 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3712 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3713 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3714 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3715 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3716 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3717 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3718 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3719
3720 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003721 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003722 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003723 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003724 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3725
3726 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3727 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003728 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003729 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3730
3731 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3732 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3733
3734
3735option clitcpka
3736no option clitcpka
3737 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3739 yes | yes | yes | no
3740 Arguments : none
3741
3742 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3743 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3744 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3745 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3746
3747 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3748 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3749 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3750 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3751
3752 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3753 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3754 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3755 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3756 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3757
3758 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3759
3760 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3761 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3762 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3763
3764 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3765 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3766
3767 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3768
3769
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003770option contstats
3771 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3773 yes | yes | yes | no
3774 Arguments : none
3775
3776 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3777 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3778 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3779 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3780 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3781 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3782 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3783
3784
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003785option dontlog-normal
3786no option dontlog-normal
3787 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3789 yes | yes | yes | no
3790 Arguments : none
3791
3792 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3793 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3794 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3795 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3796 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3797 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3798 logged.
3799
3800 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3801 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3802 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3803
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003804 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003805 logging.
3806
3807
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003808option dontlognull
3809no option dontlognull
3810 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3812 yes | yes | yes | no
3813 Arguments : none
3814
3815 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3816 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3817 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3818 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3819 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3820 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3821 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3822
3823 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3824 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3825 would not be logged.
3826
3827 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3828 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3829
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003830 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003831
3832
3833option forceclose
3834no option forceclose
3835 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003837 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003838 Arguments : none
3839
3840 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3841 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3842 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3843 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3844 global session times in the logs.
3845
3846 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003847 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003848 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003849
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003850 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3851 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3852 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3853
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003854 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3855 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003856
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003857 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3858 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3859
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003860 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003861
3862
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003863option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003864 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3866 yes | yes | yes | yes
3867 Arguments :
3868 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3869 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003870 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003871 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003872
3873 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3874 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3875 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3876 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3877 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3878 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3879 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003880 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3881 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3882 possible that the client has already brought one.
3883
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003884 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003885 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003886 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3887 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003888 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3889 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003890
3891 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3892 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3893 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3894 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3895 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3896 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3897 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3898
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003899 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3900 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3901 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3902 are under the control of the end-user.
3903
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003904 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003905 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3906 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003907 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3908 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3909 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003910
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003911 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003912 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3913 frontend www
3914 mode http
3915 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3916
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003917 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3918 backend www
3919 mode http
3920 option forwardfor header X-Client
3921
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003922 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003923 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003924
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003925
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003926option http-keep-alive
3927no option http-keep-alive
3928 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
3929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3930 yes | yes | yes | yes
3931 Arguments : none
3932
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003933 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
3934 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
3935 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
3936 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
3937 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
3938 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
3939 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
3940
3941 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
3942 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003943 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
3944 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
3945 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
3946 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
3947 situations where this option may be useful :
3948
3949 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
3950 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
3951
3952 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
3953 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
3954
3955 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
3956 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
3957 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
3958 request.
3959
3960 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
3961 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003962 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
3963 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
3964 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003965
3966 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
3967 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
3968
3969 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3970 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3971 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3972 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
3973 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3974 not set.
3975
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003976 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3977 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003978 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003979 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003980
3981 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003982 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3983 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003984
3985
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003986option http-no-delay
3987no option http-no-delay
3988 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3990 yes | yes | yes | yes
3991 Arguments : none
3992
3993 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3994 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3995 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3996 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3997 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3998 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3999 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4000 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4001 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4002 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4003 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4004 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4005 affected.
4006
4007 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4008 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4009 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4010 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4011 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4012 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4013 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4014 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4015 latency environments.
4016
4017
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004018option http-pretend-keepalive
4019no option http-pretend-keepalive
4020 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4022 yes | yes | yes | yes
4023 Arguments : none
4024
4025 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4026 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4027 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4028 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4029 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4030 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4031 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4032 consider the response complete.
4033
4034 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4035 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4036 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4037 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4038 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4039 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4040
4041 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4042 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4043 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4044 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4045 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4046 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4047 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4048
4049 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4050 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004051 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004052 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4053 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004054
4055 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4056 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4057
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004058 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4059 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004060
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004061
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004062option http-server-close
4063no option http-server-close
4064 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4066 yes | yes | yes | yes
4067 Arguments : none
4068
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004069 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4070 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4071 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4072 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4073 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4074 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4075 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4076 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4077 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4078 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4079 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4080 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4081 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4082 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4083 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4084 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004085
4086 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4087 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4088 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4089 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004090 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4091 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004092
4093 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4094 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004095 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4096 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004097 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4098 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004099
4100 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4101 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4102
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004103 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004104 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4105 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004106
4107
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004108option http-tunnel
4109no option http-tunnel
4110 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4112 yes | yes | yes | yes
4113 Arguments : none
4114
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004115 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4116 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4117 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4118 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4119 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4120 "option http-tunnel".
4121
4122 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004123 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004124 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4125 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4126 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4127 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4128 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4129 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4130 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004131
4132 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4133 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4134
4135 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4136 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4137 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4138
4139
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004140option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004141no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004142 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4144 yes | yes | yes | no
4145 Arguments : none
4146
4147 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4148 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4149 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4150 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4151 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4152 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4153 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4154
4155 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4156 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4157 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4158 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4159 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4160 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4161 request along its whole life.
4162
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004163 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4164 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4165 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4166 front of an existing proxy.
4167
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004168 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4169
4170 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4171 http-server-close".
4172
4173
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004174option httpchk
4175option httpchk <uri>
4176option httpchk <method> <uri>
4177option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4178 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4180 yes | no | yes | yes
4181 Arguments :
4182 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4183 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4184 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4185 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4186 ones.
4187
4188 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4189 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4190 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4191
4192 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4193 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4194 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4195 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4196 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4197
4198 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4199 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4200 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4201 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4202 the lack of any response.
4203
4204 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4205
4206 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4207 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4208 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4209
4210 Examples :
4211 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4212 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4213 backend https_relay
4214 mode tcp
4215 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4216 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4217
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004218 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4219 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4220 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004221
4222
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004223option httpclose
4224no option httpclose
4225 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4227 yes | yes | yes | yes
4228 Arguments : none
4229
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004230 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4231 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4232 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4233 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004234 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004235 "option http-tunnel".
4236
4237 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4238 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4239 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4240 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4241 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4242 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4243 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4244 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004245
4246 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004247 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004248 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4249 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4250 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4251 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4252 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004253
4254 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4255 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004256 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4257 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004258 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4259 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004260
4261 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4262 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4263
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004264 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4265 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004266
4267
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004268option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004269 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4271 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004272 Arguments :
4273 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4274 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4275 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4276 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4277 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004278
4279 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4280 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4281 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4282 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4283 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4284 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4285 ports.
4286
4287 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4288
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004289 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4290 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4291 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4292 by default.
4293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004294 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004295
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004296
4297option http_proxy
4298no option http_proxy
4299 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4301 yes | yes | yes | yes
4302 Arguments : none
4303
4304 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4305 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4306 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4307 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4308 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4309
4310 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4311 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4312 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4313 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004314 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004315 be analyzed.
4316
4317 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4318 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4319
4320 Example :
4321 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4322 backend direct_forward
4323 option httpclose
4324 option http_proxy
4325
4326 See also : "option httpclose"
4327
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004328
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004329option independent-streams
4330no option independent-streams
4331 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4333 yes | yes | yes | yes
4334 Arguments : none
4335
4336 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4337 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4338 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4339 receive data or not.
4340
4341 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4342 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4343 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4344 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4345 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4346 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4347 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4348 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4349 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4350 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4351 socket buffers.
4352
4353 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4354 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4355 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4356 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4357 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4358
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004359 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004360 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4361 deprecated.
4362
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004363 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004364
4365
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004366option ldap-check
4367 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4369 yes | no | yes | yes
4370 Arguments : none
4371
4372 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4373 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4374 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4375 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4376
4377 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4378 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4379
4380 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4381 configure it.
4382
4383 Example :
4384 option ldap-check
4385
4386 See also : "option httpchk"
4387
4388
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004389option log-health-checks
4390no option log-health-checks
4391 Enable or disable logging of health checks
4392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4393 yes | no | yes | yes
4394 Arguments : none
4395
4396 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
4397 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
4398 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
4399 of additional information is limited.
4400
4401 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
4402 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
4403
4404 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
4405
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004406
4407option log-separate-errors
4408no option log-separate-errors
4409 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4411 yes | yes | yes | no
4412 Arguments : none
4413
4414 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4415 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4416 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4417 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4418 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4419 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4420 provides very important information.
4421
4422 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4423 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4424 error logs.
4425
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004426 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004427 logging.
4428
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004429
4430option logasap
4431no option logasap
4432 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4434 yes | yes | yes | no
4435 Arguments : none
4436
4437 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4438 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4439 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4440 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4441 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4442 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4443 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004444 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004445 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4446 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4447
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004448 Examples :
4449 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4450 mode http
4451 option httplog
4452 option logasap
4453 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4454
4455 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4456 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4457 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4458 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4459
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004460 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004461 logging.
4462
4463
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004464option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
4465 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4467 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004468 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004469 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4470 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004471
4472 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4473 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4474 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4475 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4476 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4477 in the MySQL table, like this :
4478
4479 USE mysql;
4480 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4481 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4482
4483 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4484 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4485 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4486 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4487 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4488 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4489 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4490 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4491 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4492
4493 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4494 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004495
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004496 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004497
4498 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4499 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4500 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4501 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4502 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4503 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4504
4505 See also: "option httpchk"
4506
4507
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004508option nolinger
4509no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004510 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004511 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4512 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004513 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004514
4515 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4516 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4517 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4518 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4519 connections.
4520
4521 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4522 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4523 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4524 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4525 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4526 this too.
4527
4528 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4529 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4530 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4531
4532 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4533 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4534 for servers.
4535
4536 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4537 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4538
4539
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004540option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4541 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4543 yes | yes | yes | yes
4544 Arguments :
4545 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4546 matching <network>
4547 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4548 header name.
4549
4550 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4551 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4552 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4553 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4554 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4555 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4556 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4557 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4558 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4559 possible that the client has already brought one.
4560
4561 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4562 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4563 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4564 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4565 header and requires different one.
4566
4567 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4568 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4569 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4570 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4571 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4572 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4573 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4574
4575 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4576 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4577 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4578 both are defined.
4579
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004580 Examples :
4581 # Original Destination address
4582 frontend www
4583 mode http
4584 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4585
4586 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4587 backend www
4588 mode http
4589 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4590
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004591 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4592 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004593
4594
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004595option persist
4596no option persist
4597 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4598 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4599 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004600 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004601
4602 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4603 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4604 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4605 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4606 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4607 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4608 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4609 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4610 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4611 redirected to another valid server.
4612
4613 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4614 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4615
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004616 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004617
4618
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004619option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4620 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4622 yes | no | yes | yes
4623 Arguments :
4624 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4625 PostgreSQL server.
4626
4627 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4628 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4629 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4630 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4631
4632 See also: "option httpchk"
4633
4634
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004635option prefer-last-server
4636no option prefer-last-server
4637 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4638 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4639 yes | no | yes | yes
4640 Arguments : none
4641
4642 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4643 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4644 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4645 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4646 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4647 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4648 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4649 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4650 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004651 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4652 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4653 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4654 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4655 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4656 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4657 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004658
4659 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4660 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4661
4662 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4663
4664
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004665option redispatch
4666no option redispatch
4667 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4668 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4669 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004670 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004671
4672 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4673 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4674 be able to access the service anymore.
4675
4676 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4677 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4678
4679 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4680 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4681 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004682
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004683 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4684 "redisp" keywords.
4685
4686 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4687 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4688
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004689 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004690
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004691
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004692option redis-check
4693 Use redis health checks for server testing
4694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4695 yes | no | yes | yes
4696 Arguments : none
4697
4698 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4699 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4700 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4701 find the "+PONG" response message.
4702
4703 Example :
4704 option redis-check
4705
4706 See also : "option httpchk"
4707
4708
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004709option smtpchk
4710option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4711 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4713 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004714 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004715 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4716 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4717 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4718
4719 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4720 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4721 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4722
4723 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4724 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4725 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4726 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4727 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4728 dead server.
4729
4730 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4731 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4732 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4733 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4734
4735 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4736 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4737 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4738 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4739 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4740
4741 Example :
4742 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4743
4744 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4745
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004746
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004747option socket-stats
4748no option socket-stats
4749
4750 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4752 yes | yes | yes | no
4753
4754 Arguments : none
4755
4756
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004757option splice-auto
4758no option splice-auto
4759 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4761 yes | yes | yes | yes
4762 Arguments : none
4763
4764 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4765 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4766 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4767 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004768 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004769 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4770 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4771 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4772 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4773
4774 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4775 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4776 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4777 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4778 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4779 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4780 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4781 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4782 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4783 keyword.
4784
4785 Example :
4786 option splice-auto
4787
4788 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4789 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4790
4791 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4792 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4793
4794
4795option splice-request
4796no option splice-request
4797 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4799 yes | yes | yes | yes
4800 Arguments : none
4801
4802 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004803 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004804 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4805 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4806 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4807 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4808
4809 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4810
4811 Example :
4812 option splice-request
4813
4814 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4815 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4816
4817 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4818 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4819
4820
4821option splice-response
4822no option splice-response
4823 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4825 yes | yes | yes | yes
4826 Arguments : none
4827
4828 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004829 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004830 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4831 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4832 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4833 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4834
4835 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4836
4837 Example :
4838 option splice-response
4839
4840 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4841 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4842
4843 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4844 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4845
4846
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004847option srvtcpka
4848no option srvtcpka
4849 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4851 yes | no | yes | yes
4852 Arguments : none
4853
4854 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4855 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4856 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4857 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4858
4859 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4860 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4861 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4862 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4863
4864 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4865 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4866 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4867 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4868 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4869
4870 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4871
4872 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4873 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4874 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4875
4876 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4877 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4878
4879 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4880
4881
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004882option ssl-hello-chk
4883 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4885 yes | no | yes | yes
4886 Arguments : none
4887
4888 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4889 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4890 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4891 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4892 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4893 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4894 hello message.
4895
4896 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4897 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4898 messages, which is appreciable.
4899
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004900 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4901 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4902 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004903
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004904 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4905
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004906
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004907option tcp-check
4908 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
4909 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4910 yes | no | yes | yes
4911
4912 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
4913 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
4914
4915 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
4916 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
4917 attempt, which remains the default mode.
4918
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004919 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004920 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
4921 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
4922 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
4923 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
4924 only.
4925
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004926 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004927 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
4928 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
4929 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
4930 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
4931
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004932 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004933 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
4934 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004935 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004936 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
4937 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
4938 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
4939 the respective protocols.
4940 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
4941 analysed.
4942
4943 Examples :
4944 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
4945 option tcp-check
4946 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
4947
4948 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
4949 option tcp-check
4950 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
4951
4952 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
4953 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004954 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004955 option tcp-check
4956 tcp-check send PING\r\n
4957 tcp-check expect +PONG
4958 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
4959 tcp-check expect string role:master
4960 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
4961 tcp-check expect string +OK
4962
4963 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
4964 (send many headers before analyzing)
4965 option tcp-check
4966 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
4967 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
4968 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
4969 tcp-check send \r\n
4970 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
4971
4972
4973 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
4974
4975
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004976option tcp-smart-accept
4977no option tcp-smart-accept
4978 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4980 yes | yes | yes | no
4981 Arguments : none
4982
4983 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4984 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4985 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4986 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4987 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4988 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4989
4990 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4991 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4992 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4993 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4994
4995 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4996 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4997 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4998 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4999
5000 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5001 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5002 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5003
5004 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5005 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5006 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5007
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005008 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5009
5010
5011option tcp-smart-connect
5012no option tcp-smart-connect
5013 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5015 yes | no | yes | yes
5016 Arguments : none
5017
5018 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5019 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5020 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5021 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5022 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5023
5024 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5025 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5026 complex.
5027
5028 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5029 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5030 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5031
5032 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5033 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5034
5035 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5036
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005037
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005038option tcpka
5039 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5041 yes | yes | yes | yes
5042 Arguments : none
5043
5044 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5045 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5046 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5047 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5048
5049 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5050 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5051 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5052 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5053
5054 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5055 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5056 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5057 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5058 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5059
5060 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5061
5062 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5063 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5064 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5065 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5066 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5067 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5068 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5069 backends.
5070
5071 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5072
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005073
5074option tcplog
5075 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5077 yes | yes | yes | yes
5078 Arguments : none
5079
5080 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5081 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5082 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5083 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5084 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5085 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5086 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5087 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5088
5089 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5090
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005091 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005092
5093
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005094option transparent
5095no option transparent
5096 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005098 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005099 Arguments : none
5100
5101 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5102 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5103 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5104 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5105 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5106 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5107 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5108 appropriate server.
5109
5110 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5111 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5112
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005113 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005114 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005115
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005116
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005117persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005118persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005119 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5121 yes | no | yes | yes
5122 Arguments :
5123 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005124 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5125 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005126
5127 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5128 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5129 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5130 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5131 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5132 forwarded to this server.
5133
5134 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5135 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5136 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005137 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005138 a single "listen" section.
5139
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005140 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5141 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5142 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5143
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005144 Example :
5145 listen tse-farm
5146 bind :3389
5147 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5148 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5149 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5150 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5151 persist rdp-cookie
5152 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005153 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005154 balance rdp-cookie
5155 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5156 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5157
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005158 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5159 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005160
5161
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005162rate-limit sessions <rate>
5163 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5165 yes | yes | yes | no
5166 Arguments :
5167 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5168 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5169
5170 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5171 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5172 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5173 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5174 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5175 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5176
5177 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5178 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5179 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5180 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5181
5182 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5183 listen smtp
5184 mode tcp
5185 bind :25
5186 rate-limit sessions 10
5187 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5188
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005189 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5190 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5191 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005192
5193 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5194
5195
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005196redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5197redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5198redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005199 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5201 no | yes | yes | yes
5202
5203 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005204 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005205
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005206 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005207 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005208 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5209 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5210 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005211
5212 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5213 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5214 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5215 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5216 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005217 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5218 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5219 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5220 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005221
5222 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5223 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5224 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5225 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5226 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5227 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005228 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005229 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005230 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5231 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5232 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005233
5234 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005235 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5236 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5237 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5238 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5239 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5240 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5241 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5242 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005243
5244 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5245 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5246
5247 - "drop-query"
5248 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5249 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5250 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5251 with a location-type redirect.
5252
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005253 - "append-slash"
5254 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5255 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5256 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5257 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5258
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005259 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5260 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5261 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5262 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5263 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5264 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5265 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5266
5267 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5268 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5269 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5270 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5271 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5272 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5273 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005274
5275 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5276 acl clear dst_port 80
5277 acl secure dst_port 8080
5278 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005279 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005280 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005281 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5282
5283 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005284 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5285 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5286 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005287 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005288
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005289 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5290 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5291 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5292
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005293 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005294 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005295
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005296 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5297 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5298 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5299
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005300 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005301
5302
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005303redisp (deprecated)
5304redispatch (deprecated)
5305 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5306 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5307 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005308 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005309
5310 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5311 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5312 be able to access the service anymore.
5313
5314 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5315 redistribute them to a working server.
5316
5317 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5318 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5319 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005320
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005321 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5322 "option redispatch" instead.
5323
5324 See also : "option redispatch"
5325
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005326
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005327reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005328 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5330 no | yes | yes | yes
5331 Arguments :
5332 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5333 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005334 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005335
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005336 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5337 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5338
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005339 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5340 the last header of an HTTP request.
5341
5342 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5343 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5344 responses.
5345
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005346 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5347 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5348 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5349
5350 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5351 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005352
5353
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005354reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5355reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005356 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5358 no | yes | yes | yes
5359 Arguments :
5360 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5361 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5362 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5363 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5364 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5365 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5366 ignores case.
5367
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005368 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5369 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5370
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005371 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5372 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5373 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5374 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005375 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005376
5377 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5378 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5379
5380 Example :
5381 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5382 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5383 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5384
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005385 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5386 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005387
5388
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005389reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5390reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005391 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5393 no | yes | yes | yes
5394 Arguments :
5395 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5396 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5397 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5398 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5399 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5400 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5401
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005402 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5403 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5404
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005405 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5406 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5407 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5408 next servers.
5409
5410 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5411 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5412 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5413
5414 Example :
5415 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5416 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5417 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5418
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005419 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5420 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005421
5422
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005423reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5424reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005425 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5427 no | yes | yes | yes
5428 Arguments :
5429 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5430 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5431 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5432 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5433 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5434 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5435 case.
5436
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005437 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5438 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5439
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005440 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5441 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5442 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5443 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005444 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005445
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005446 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005447 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005448 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005449
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005450 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5451 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5452
5453 Example :
5454 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5455 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5456 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5457
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005458 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5459 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005460
5461
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005462reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5463reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005464 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5466 no | yes | yes | yes
5467 Arguments :
5468 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5469 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5470 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5471 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5472 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5473 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5474 case.
5475
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005476 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5477 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5478
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005479 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5480 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5481 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5482 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5483
5484 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5485 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5486
5487 Example :
5488 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5489 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5490 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5491 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5492
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005493 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5494 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005495
5496
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005497reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5498reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005499 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5501 no | yes | yes | yes
5502 Arguments :
5503 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5504 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5505 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5506 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5507 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5508 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5509
5510 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5511 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5512 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5513 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005514 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005515
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005516 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5517 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5518
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005519 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5520 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5521 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5522
5523 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5524 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5525 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5526 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5527 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5528
5529 Example :
5530 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005531 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005532 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5533 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5534
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005535 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5536 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005537
5538
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005539reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5540reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005541 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5543 no | yes | yes | yes
5544 Arguments :
5545 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5546 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5547 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5548 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5549 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5550 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5551 ignores case.
5552
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005553 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5554 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5555
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005556 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5557 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005558 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5559 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5560 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005561 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5562 not set.
5563
5564 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5565 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5566 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5567 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5568 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5569
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005570 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005571 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5572 # block all others.
5573 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5574 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5575
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005576 # block bad guys
5577 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5578 reqitarpit . if badguys
5579
5580 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5581 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005582
5583
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005584retries <value>
5585 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5586 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5587 yes | no | yes | yes
5588 Arguments :
5589 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5590 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5591 default value is 3.
5592
5593 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5594 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5595 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5596
5597 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5598 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5599
5600 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5601 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5602
5603 See also : "option redispatch"
5604
5605
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005606rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005607 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5609 no | yes | yes | yes
5610 Arguments :
5611 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5612 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005613 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005614
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005615 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5616 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5617
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005618 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5619 the last header of an HTTP response.
5620
5621 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5622 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5623 responses.
5624
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005625 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5626 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005627
5628
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005629rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5630rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005631 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5633 no | yes | yes | yes
5634 Arguments :
5635 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5636 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5637 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5638 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5639 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5640 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5641 ignores case.
5642
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005643 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5644 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5645
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005646 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5647 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005648 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005649 client.
5650
5651 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5652 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5653 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5654
5655 Example :
5656 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005657 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005658
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005659 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5660 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005661
5662
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005663rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5664rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005665 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5667 no | yes | yes | yes
5668 Arguments :
5669 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5670 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5671 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5672 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5673 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5674 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5675 ignores case.
5676
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005677 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5678 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5679
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005680 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5681 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5682 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5683 case-sensitive.
5684
5685 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005686 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5687 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5688 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005689
5690 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5691 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5692
5693 Example :
5694 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5695 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5696
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005697 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5698 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005699
5700
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005701rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5702rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005703 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5705 no | yes | yes | yes
5706 Arguments :
5707 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5708 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5709 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5710 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5711 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5712 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5713 ignores case.
5714
5715 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5716 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5717 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5718 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005719 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005720
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005721 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5722 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5723
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005724 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5725 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5726 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5727
5728 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5729 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5730 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5731 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5732 are not case-sensitive.
5733
5734 Example :
5735 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5736 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5737
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005738 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5739 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005740
5741
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005742server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005743 Declare a server in a backend
5744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5745 no | no | yes | yes
5746 Arguments :
5747 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005748 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005749 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005750
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005751 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5752 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5753 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5754 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005755 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5756 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5757 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5758 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5759 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005760 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5761 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5762 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5763 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5764 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5765 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5766 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005767 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5768 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5769 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5770 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005771
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005772 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005773 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5774 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5775 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5776 adding this value to the client's port.
5777
5778 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5779 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005780 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005781
5782 Examples :
5783 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5784 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005785 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005786 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5787 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5788 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005789
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005790 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5791 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005792
5793
5794source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005795source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005796source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005797 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5799 yes | no | yes | yes
5800 Arguments :
5801 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5802 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005803
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005804 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005805 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5806 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5807 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5808 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5809 supported prefixes are :
5810 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5811 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5812 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005813 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5814 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5815 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5816 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005817
5818 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5819 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005820 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5821 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5822 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005823
5824 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5825 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5826 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5827 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5828 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5829 <addr>.
5830
5831 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5832 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5833 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5834 port.
5835
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005836 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5837 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5838 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5839 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005840 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005841 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5842 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5843 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5844 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5845 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5846 HTTP header.
5847
5848 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5849 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005850 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005851 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5852 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5853 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5854 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5855 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5856 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5857 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5858
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005859 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5860 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5861 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5862 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5863 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5864 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5865
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005866 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5867 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5868 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5869 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5870
5871 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5872 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5873 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5874 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5875 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5876 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5877
5878 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5879 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5880 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5881 there are two methods :
5882
5883 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5884 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5885 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5886 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5887 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5888 of the client ranges may be used.
5889
5890 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5891 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5892 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5893 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5894 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5895 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5896 same session.
5897
5898 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5899 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5900 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5901 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5902 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5903 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5904
5905 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5906 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5907 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005908 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005909
5910 Examples :
5911 backend private
5912 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5913 source 192.168.1.200
5914
5915 backend transparent_ssl1
5916 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5917 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5918
5919 backend transparent_ssl2
5920 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5921 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5922 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5923
5924 backend transparent_ssl3
5925 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5926 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5927 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5928
5929 backend transparent_smtp
5930 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5931 # with Tproxy version 4.
5932 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5933
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005934 backend transparent_http
5935 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5936 # proxy.
5937 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5938
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005939 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005940 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5941
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005942
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005943srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5944 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5946 yes | no | yes | yes
5947 Arguments :
5948 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5949 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5950 as explained at the top of this document.
5951
5952 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5953 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5954 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5955 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5956 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5957 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5958 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5959
5960 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5961 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5962 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5963 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5964 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005965 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005966 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005967 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005968
5969 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5970 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5971 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5972 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5973 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5974 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5975
5976 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5977 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5978
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005979 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5980 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005981
5982
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005983stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5984 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02005986 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005987
5988 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5989 matched.
5990
5991 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5992 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5993
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005994 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5995 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5996 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5997
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005998 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5999 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6000 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6001 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006002
6003 Example :
6004 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6005 backend stats_localhost
6006 stats enable
6007 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6008
6009 Example :
6010 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6011 backend stats_auth
6012 stats enable
6013 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6014 stats admin if TRUE
6015
6016 Example :
6017 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6018 userlist stats-auth
6019 group admin users admin
6020 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6021 group readonly users haproxy
6022 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6023
6024 backend stats_auth
6025 stats enable
6026 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6027 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6028 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6029 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6030
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006031 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6032 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6033 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006034
6035
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006036stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6037 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006039 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006040 Arguments :
6041 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6042
6043 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6044
6045 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6046 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6047 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6048 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6049 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6050 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6051
6052 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6053 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6054 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006055 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006056
6057 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6058 report using "stats scope".
6059
6060 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6061 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6062 unobvious parameters.
6063
6064 Example :
6065 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6066 backend public_www
6067 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6068 stats enable
6069 stats hide-version
6070 stats scope .
6071 stats uri /admin?stats
6072 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6073 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6074 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6075
6076 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6077 backend private_monitoring
6078 stats enable
6079 stats uri /admin?stats
6080 stats refresh 5s
6081
6082 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6083
6084
6085stats enable
6086 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006088 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006089 Arguments : none
6090
6091 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6092 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6093 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6094 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6095 - stats auth : no authentication
6096 - stats scope : no restriction
6097
6098 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6099 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6100 unobvious parameters.
6101
6102 Example :
6103 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6104 backend public_www
6105 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6106 stats enable
6107 stats hide-version
6108 stats scope .
6109 stats uri /admin?stats
6110 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6111 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6112 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6113
6114 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6115 backend private_monitoring
6116 stats enable
6117 stats uri /admin?stats
6118 stats refresh 5s
6119
6120 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6121
6122
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006123stats hide-version
6124 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006126 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006127 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006128
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006129 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6130 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6131 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6132 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6133 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6134 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006135
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006136 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6137 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6138 unobvious parameters.
6139
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006140 Example :
6141 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6142 backend public_www
6143 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006144 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006145 stats hide-version
6146 stats scope .
6147 stats uri /admin?stats
6148 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6149 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6150 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006151
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006152 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6153 backend private_monitoring
6154 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006155 stats uri /admin?stats
6156 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006157
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006158 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006159
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006160
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006161stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6162 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6163 Access control for statistics
6164
6165 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6166 no | no | yes | yes
6167
6168 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6169 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6170 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6171 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6172 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6173 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6174
6175 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6176 instance.
6177
6178 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6179 about ACL usage.
6180
6181
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006182stats realm <realm>
6183 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006185 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006186 Arguments :
6187 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6188 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6189 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6190
6191 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6192 using a backslash ('\').
6193
6194 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6195 only related to authentication.
6196
6197 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6198 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6199 unobvious parameters.
6200
6201 Example :
6202 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6203 backend public_www
6204 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6205 stats enable
6206 stats hide-version
6207 stats scope .
6208 stats uri /admin?stats
6209 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6210 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6211 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6212
6213 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6214 backend private_monitoring
6215 stats enable
6216 stats uri /admin?stats
6217 stats refresh 5s
6218
6219 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6220
6221
6222stats refresh <delay>
6223 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006225 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006226 Arguments :
6227 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6228 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6229 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6230 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6231 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6232 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6233
6234 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6235 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6236 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6237 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6238
6239 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6240 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6241 unobvious parameters.
6242
6243 Example :
6244 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6245 backend public_www
6246 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6247 stats enable
6248 stats hide-version
6249 stats scope .
6250 stats uri /admin?stats
6251 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6252 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6253 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6254
6255 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6256 backend private_monitoring
6257 stats enable
6258 stats uri /admin?stats
6259 stats refresh 5s
6260
6261 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6262
6263
6264stats scope { <name> | "." }
6265 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006267 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006268 Arguments :
6269 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6270 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6271 section in which the statement appears.
6272
6273 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6274 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6275 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6276 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6277 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6278 exists.
6279
6280 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6281 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6282 unobvious parameters.
6283
6284 Example :
6285 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6286 backend public_www
6287 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6288 stats enable
6289 stats hide-version
6290 stats scope .
6291 stats uri /admin?stats
6292 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6293 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6294 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6295
6296 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6297 backend private_monitoring
6298 stats enable
6299 stats uri /admin?stats
6300 stats refresh 5s
6301
6302 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6303
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006304
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006305stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006306 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006308 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006309
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006310 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006311 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6312
6313 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6314 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6315
6316 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6317 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006318 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006319
6320 Example :
6321 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6322 backend private_monitoring
6323 stats enable
6324 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6325 stats uri /admin?stats
6326 stats refresh 5s
6327
6328 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6329 global section.
6330
6331
6332stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006333 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6335 yes | yes | yes | yes
6336 Arguments : none
6337
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006338 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006339 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6340 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6341 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6342 - IP (socket, server)
6343 - cookie (backend, server)
6344
6345 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6346 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006347 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006348
6349 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6350
6351
6352stats show-node [ <name> ]
6353 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006355 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006356 Arguments:
6357 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6358 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6359
6360 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6361 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006362 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006363
6364 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6365 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6366 unobvious parameters.
6367
6368 Example:
6369 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6370 backend private_monitoring
6371 stats enable
6372 stats show-node Europe-1
6373 stats uri /admin?stats
6374 stats refresh 5s
6375
6376 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6377 section.
6378
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006379
6380stats uri <prefix>
6381 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006383 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006384 Arguments :
6385 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6386 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6387 query string.
6388
6389 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6390 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6391 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6392 possible to reach it in the application.
6393
6394 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006395 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006396 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6397 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6398 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6399 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6400
6401 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6402 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6403 an address or a port to statistics only.
6404
6405 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6406 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6407 unobvious parameters.
6408
6409 Example :
6410 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6411 backend public_www
6412 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6413 stats enable
6414 stats hide-version
6415 stats scope .
6416 stats uri /admin?stats
6417 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6418 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6419 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6420
6421 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6422 backend private_monitoring
6423 stats enable
6424 stats uri /admin?stats
6425 stats refresh 5s
6426
6427 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6428
6429
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006430stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6431 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006433 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006434
6435 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006436 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006437 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6438 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6439 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6440
6441 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6442 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6443 the "stick-table" statement.
6444
6445 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6446 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6447 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6448 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6449 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6450
6451 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6452 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6453 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6454 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6455 transformation rules.
6456
6457 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6458 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6459 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6460 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6461 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6462 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6463 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6464
6465 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6466 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6467 ACL based conditions.
6468
6469 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6470 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6471 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6472 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6473
6474 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6475 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6476 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6477 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6478
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006479 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6480 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6481 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6482
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006483 Example :
6484 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6485 # last 30 minutes
6486 backend pop
6487 mode tcp
6488 balance roundrobin
6489 stick store-request src
6490 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6491 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6492 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6493
6494 backend smtp
6495 mode tcp
6496 balance roundrobin
6497 stick match src table pop
6498 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6499 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6500
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006501 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6502 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006503
6504
6505stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6506 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6508 no | no | yes | yes
6509
6510 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6511 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6512 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6513 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6514
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006515 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6516 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6517 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6518
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006519 Examples :
6520 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006521 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006522
6523 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6524 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6525 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6526
6527
6528 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6529 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6530 backend http
6531 mode http
6532 balance roundrobin
6533 stick on src table https
6534 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6535 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6536 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6537
6538 backend https
6539 mode tcp
6540 balance roundrobin
6541 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6542 stick on src
6543 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6544 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6545
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006546 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006547
6548
6549stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6550 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6552 no | no | yes | yes
6553
6554 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006555 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006556 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6557 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6558 server is selected.
6559
6560 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6561 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6562 the "stick-table" statement.
6563
6564 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6565 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6566 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6567 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6568 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6569 address.
6570
6571 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6572 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6573 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6574 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6575 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6576 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6577 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6578 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6579 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6580 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6581
6582 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6583 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6584 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6585 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6586 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6587 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6588 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6589
6590 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6591 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6592 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6593 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6594
6595 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6596 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6597 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6598 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6599 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6600 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006601 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6602 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6603 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6604 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6605 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6606 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006607
6608 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6609 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6610 the request.
6611
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006612 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6613 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6614 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6615
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006616 Example :
6617 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6618 # last 30 minutes
6619 backend pop
6620 mode tcp
6621 balance roundrobin
6622 stick store-request src
6623 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6624 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6625 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6626
6627 backend smtp
6628 mode tcp
6629 balance roundrobin
6630 stick match src table pop
6631 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6632 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6633
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006634 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6635 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006636
6637
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006638stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006639 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6640 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006641 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006643 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006644
6645 Arguments :
6646 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6647 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6648 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6649 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6650
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006651 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6652 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6653 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6654 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6655
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006656 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6657 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6658 instance.
6659
6660 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6661 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6662 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6663 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6664 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6665 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006666 to 32 characters.
6667
6668 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6669 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6670 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6671 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
6672 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6673 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006674
6675 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006676 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6677 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006678 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6679 increase.
6680
6681 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006682 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6683 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6684 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006685
6686 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6687 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6688 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6689 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6690 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6691 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6692 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6693 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6694 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6695 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6696 parameter (see below).
6697
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006698 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6699 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6700 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6701 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6702 soft restart.
6703
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006704 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6705
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006706 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6707 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6708 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6709 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6710 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006711 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006712 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6713 if not expiration delay is specified.
6714
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006715 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6716 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6717 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6718 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006719 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6720 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6721 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6722 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6723 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6724 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6725 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6726 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6727 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6728 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6729 types and their arguments.
6730
6731 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6732 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6733 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6734 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6735
6736 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6737 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6738 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6739 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6740
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006741 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6742 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6743 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6744 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6745 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6746 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6747
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006748 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6749 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6750 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6751 they were received.
6752
6753 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6754 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6755 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6756 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6757 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6758
6759 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6760 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6761 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6762 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6763 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6764
6765 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6766 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6767 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6768
6769 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6770 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6771 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6772 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6773 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6774
6775 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6776 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6777 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6778 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6779 the client side.
6780
6781 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6782 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6783 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6784 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6785 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6786 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6787 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6788
6789 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6790 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6791 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6792 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6793 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6794 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6795 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6796
6797 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6798 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6799 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6800 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6801 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6802 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6803
6804 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6805 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6806 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6807 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6808
6809 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6810 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6811 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6812 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6813 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6814 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6815 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6816 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6817 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6818 recommended for better fairness.
6819
6820 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6821 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6822 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6823 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6824
6825 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6826 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6827 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6828 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6829 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6830 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6831 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6832 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6833 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6834 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006835
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006836 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6837 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006838 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6839 reference it.
6840
6841 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6842 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6843 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6844 as an exclusive stickiness.
6845
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006846 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6847 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6848 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6849 something that can be ignored.
6850
6851 Example:
6852 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6853 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6854 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6855 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6856
6857 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006858 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006859
6860
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006861stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6862 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6864 no | no | yes | yes
6865
6866 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006867 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006868 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6869 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6870 server is selected.
6871
6872 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6873 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6874 the "stick-table" statement.
6875
6876 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6877 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6878 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6879 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6880
6881 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6882 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6883 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6884 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6885 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6886 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006887 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006888 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6889 rules.
6890
6891 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6892 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6893 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6894 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6895 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6896 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6897 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6898
6899 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6900 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6901 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6902 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6903
6904 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6905 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6906 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6907 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6908 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6909 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006910 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
6911 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6912 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6913 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6914 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6915 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
6916 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
6917 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
6918 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006919
6920 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6921
6922 Example :
6923 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6924 backend https
6925 mode tcp
6926 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006927 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006928 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006929
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006930 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6931 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6932
6933 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6934 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6935 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6936
6937 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6938 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006939
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006940 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6941 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6942 # at offset 44.
6943
6944 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6945 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6946
6947 # Learn on response if server hello.
6948 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006949
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006950 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6951 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6952
6953 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6954 extraction.
6955
6956
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006957tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6958 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6960 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006961 Arguments :
6962 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02006963 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
6964 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02006965
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006966 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006967
6968 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
6969 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006970 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
6971 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
6972 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
6973 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
6974 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
6975 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006976
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006977 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
6978 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
6979 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
6980 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006981
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006982 Three types of actions are supported :
6983 - accept :
6984 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6985 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6986 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006987
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006988 - reject :
6989 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6990 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6991 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6992 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6993 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6994 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6995 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6996 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6997 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6998 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6999 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7000 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007001
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007002 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7003 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7004 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7005 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7006 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7007 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7008 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7009 hosts.
7010
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007011 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007012 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7013 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7014 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007015 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7016 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007017 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007018 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7019 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7020 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7021 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7022 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007023
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007024 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007025 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007026 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007027 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7028 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7029 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7030 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007031
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007032 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7033 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7034 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7035 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007036
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007037 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7038 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7039 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7040 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7041 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007042 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7043 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7044 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7045 layer7 information is extracted.
7046
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007047 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7048 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7049 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7050 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7051 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007052
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007053 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7054 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7055 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007056
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007057 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7058 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7059 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007060
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007061 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007062 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007063 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007064
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007065 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7066 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7067 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007068
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007069 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007070 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7071 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007072
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007073 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7074
7075 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7076
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007077 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7078
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007079 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007080
7081
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007082tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7083 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007085 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007086 Arguments :
7087 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007088 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7089 and "track-sc2". See "tcp-request connection" above for their
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02007090 signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007091
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007092 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007093
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007094 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7095 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7096 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7097 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7098 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007099
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007100 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7101 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7102 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7103 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007104 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7105 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7106 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7107 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7108 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7109 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007110 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007111 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007112
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007113 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7114 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7115 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7116 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007117
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007118 Three types of actions are supported :
7119 - accept :
7120 - reject :
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007121 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007122
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007123 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7124 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007125
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007126 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7127 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7128 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7129 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7130 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7131 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007132
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007133 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007134 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7135 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007136
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007137 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007138 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7139 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7140 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7141 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007142 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7143 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7144 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007145
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007146 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
7147 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
7148 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
7149 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
7150
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007151 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007152 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7153 # and reject everything else.
7154 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7155 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007156 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007157 tcp-request content reject
7158
7159 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007160 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7161 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7162 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007163 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007164
7165 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7166 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7167 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007168 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007169 tcp-request content reject
7170
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007171 Example:
7172 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7173 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007174 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007175
7176 Example:
7177 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7178 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007179 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007180
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007181 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7182 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7183
7184 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007185 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007186 # protecting all our sites
7187 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007188 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7189 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007190 ...
7191 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7192
7193 backend http_dynamic
7194 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007195 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007196 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007197 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7198 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7199 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007200 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007201
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007202 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007203
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007204 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007205
7206
7207tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7208 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007210 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007211 Arguments :
7212 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7213 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7214 as explained at the top of this document.
7215
7216 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7217 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7218 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7219 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7220 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7221
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007222 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7223 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7224 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7225 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7226
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007227 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7228 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007229 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007230 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007231 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7232 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7233 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7234 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007235
7236 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7237 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7238 it pass through unaffected.
7239
7240 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7241 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7242 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007243 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007244 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7245 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007246 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7247 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7248 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007249
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007250 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007251 "timeout client".
7252
7253
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007254tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7255 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7257 no | no | yes | yes
7258 Arguments :
7259 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007260 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007261
7262 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7263
7264 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7265 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7266 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007267 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7268 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007269
7270 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7271
7272 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7273 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7274 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7275 inserted.
7276
7277 Two types of actions are supported :
7278 - accept :
7279 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7280 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7281 the rules evaluation.
7282
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007283 - close :
7284 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7285 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7286 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7287 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7288 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7289 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007290 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007291 protocols.
7292
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007293 - reject :
7294 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7295 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007296 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007297
7298 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7299 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7300 for changing the default action to a reject.
7301
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007302 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7303 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7304 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7305 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007306 period.
7307
7308 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7309
7310 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7311
7312
7313tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7314 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7315 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7316 no | no | yes | yes
7317 Arguments :
7318 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7319 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7320 as explained at the top of this document.
7321
7322 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7323
7324
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007325timeout check <timeout>
7326 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7327 established.
7328
7329 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7330 yes | no | yes | yes
7331 Arguments:
7332 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7333 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7334 as explained at the top of this document.
7335
7336 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7337 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7338 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7339 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007340 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7341 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7342 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007343
7344 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7345 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7346
7347 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7348 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007349 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007350
7351 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7352 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7353 forget about it.
7354
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007355 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7356 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007357
7358
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007359timeout client <timeout>
7360timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7361 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7363 yes | yes | yes | no
7364 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007365 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007366 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7367 as explained at the top of this document.
7368
7369 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7370 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7371 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7372 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7373 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7374 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7375 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7376 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007377 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007378 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007379 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7380 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
7381 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007382
7383 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7384 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7385 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7386 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7387 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7388 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7389
7390 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7391 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7392 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7393
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007394 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007395
7396
7397timeout connect <timeout>
7398timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7399 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7401 yes | no | yes | yes
7402 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007403 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007404 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7405 as explained at the top of this document.
7406
7407 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007408 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007409 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007410 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007411 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7412 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007413
7414 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7415 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7416 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7417 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7418 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7419 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7420
7421 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7422 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7423 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7424
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007425 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7426 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007427
7428
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007429timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7430 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7432 yes | yes | yes | yes
7433 Arguments :
7434 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7435 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7436 as explained at the top of this document.
7437
7438 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7439 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7440 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7441 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7442 once the request has started to present itself.
7443
7444 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7445 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7446 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7447 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7448 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7449
7450 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7451 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7452 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7453 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7454
7455 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7456 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7457 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7458 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7459 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007460 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007461
7462 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7463 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7464 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7465 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7466
7467 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7468
7469
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007470timeout http-request <timeout>
7471 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007473 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007474 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007475 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007476 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7477 as explained at the top of this document.
7478
7479 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7480 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7481 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7482 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7483 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7484 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7485 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
7486 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
7487
7488 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7489 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007490 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7491 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007492
7493 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7494 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7495 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7496 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7497 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7498
7499 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007500 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7501 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7502 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007503
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007504 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007505
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007506
7507timeout queue <timeout>
7508 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7510 yes | no | yes | yes
7511 Arguments :
7512 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7513 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7514 as explained at the top of this document.
7515
7516 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7517 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7518 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7519 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7520 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7521
7522 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7523 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7524 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7525 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7526
7527 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7528
7529
7530timeout server <timeout>
7531timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7532 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7534 yes | no | yes | yes
7535 Arguments :
7536 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7537 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7538 as explained at the top of this document.
7539
7540 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7541 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7542 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7543 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7544 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7545 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7546 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7547
7548 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7549 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7550 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7551 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7552 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007553 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007554 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007555 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7556 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7557 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7558 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007559
7560 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7561 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7562 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7563 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7564 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7565 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7566
7567 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7568 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7569 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7570
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007571 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007572
7573
7574timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007575 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7577 yes | yes | yes | yes
7578 Arguments :
7579 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7580 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7581 as explained at the top of this document.
7582
7583 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7584 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7585 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7586
7587 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7588 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7589 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7590 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007591 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007592
7593 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7594
7595
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007596timeout tunnel <timeout>
7597 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7599 yes | no | yes | yes
7600 Arguments :
7601 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7602 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7603 as explained at the top of this document.
7604
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007605 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007606 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7607 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7608 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7609 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7610 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7611 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7612 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7613 specified.
7614
7615 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7616 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7617 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7618 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7619 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7620
7621 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7622 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7623 forget about it.
7624
7625 Example :
7626 defaults http
7627 option http-server-close
7628 timeout connect 5s
7629 timeout client 30s
7630 timeout client 30s
7631 timeout server 30s
7632 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7633
7634 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
7635
7636
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007637transparent (deprecated)
7638 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007640 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007641 Arguments : none
7642
7643 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7644 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7645 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7646 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7647 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7648 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7649 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7650 appropriate server.
7651
7652 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7653
7654 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7655 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7656
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007657 See also: "option transparent"
7658
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007659unique-id-format <string>
7660 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7662 yes | yes | yes | no
7663 Arguments :
7664 <string> is a log-format string.
7665
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007666 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7667 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7668 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7669 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007670
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007671 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7672 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7673 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7674 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7675 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7676 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7677 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7678 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007679
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007680 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7681 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007682
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007683 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007684
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05007685 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007686
7687 will generate:
7688
7689 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7690
7691 See also: "unique-id-header"
7692
7693unique-id-header <name>
7694 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7696 yes | yes | yes | no
7697 Arguments :
7698 <name> is the name of the header.
7699
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007700 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7701 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007702
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007703 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007704
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05007705 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007706 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7707
7708 will generate:
7709
7710 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7711
7712 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007713
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02007714use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007715 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7717 no | yes | yes | no
7718 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007719 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
7720 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007721
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02007722 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
7723 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007724
7725 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7726 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7727 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007728 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
7729 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
7730 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
7731 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007732
7733 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
7734 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
7735 assign the backend.
7736
7737 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7738 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7739 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7740 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7741 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7742 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7743
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007744 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007745 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007746 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7747 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7748 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7749
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007750 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
7751 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
7752 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
7753 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
7754 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
7755 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
7756 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
7757 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
7758 cannot be forced from the request.
7759
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007760 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007761 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
7762 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
7763
7764 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
7765 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007766
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007767
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007768use-server <server> if <condition>
7769use-server <server> unless <condition>
7770 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
7771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7772 no | no | yes | yes
7773 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007774 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007775
7776 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
7777
7778 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
7779 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
7780 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
7781
7782 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
7783 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
7784 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
7785 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
7786 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
7787 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
7788 matches will assign the server.
7789
7790 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
7791 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
7792 with the next rules until one matches.
7793
7794 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
7795 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7796 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
7797 according to other persistence mechanisms.
7798
7799 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
7800 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
7801 stripped.
7802
7803 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
7804 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
7805 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
7806 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
7807
7808 Example :
7809 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
7810 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
7811 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
7812 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
7813 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
7814 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
7815 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
7816 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
7817 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
7818
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007819 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02007820
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007821
78225. Bind and Server options
7823--------------------------
7824
7825The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
7826depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
7827settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
7828written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
7829described in this section.
7830
7831
78325.1. Bind options
7833-----------------
7834
7835The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
7836as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
7837no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
7838parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
7839while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
7840provided immediately after the setting name.
7841
7842The currently supported settings are the following ones.
7843
7844accept-proxy
7845 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
7846 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
7847 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
7848 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
7849 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
7850 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
7851 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
7852 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
7853 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007854 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
7855 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007856
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02007857alpn <protocols>
7858 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
7859 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
7860 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
7861 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
7862 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
7863 initial NPN extension.
7864
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007865backlog <backlog>
7866 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
7867 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
7868
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007869ecdhe <named curve>
7870 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01007871 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
7872 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02007873
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007874ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007875 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7876 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
7877 client's certificate.
7878
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007879ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
7880 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
7881 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
7882 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
7883 error is ignored.
7884
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007885ciphers <ciphers>
7886 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
7887 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007888 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007889 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
7890 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
7891
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02007892crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02007893 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7894 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
7895 to verify client's certificate.
7896
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007897crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007898 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
7899 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
7900 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
7901 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
7902 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
7903 file.
7904
7905 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
7906 are loaded.
7907
7908 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
7909 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
7910 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
7911 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
7912 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
7913 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
7914 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
7915 www.sub.example.org).
7916
7917 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
7918 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
7919 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
7920 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
7921 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
7922
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02007923 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007924
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007925 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
7926 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08007927 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007928 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
7929 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
7930 clients).
7931
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007932crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007933 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
7934 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007935 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00007936 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02007937
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007938crt-list <file>
7939 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007940 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
7941 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007942
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007943 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007944
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02007945 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
7946 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
7947 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
7948 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
7949 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
7950 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
7951 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
7952 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01007953
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007954defer-accept
7955 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
7956 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
7957 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
7958 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
7959 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
7960 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
7961 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
7962 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
7963 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
7964 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
7965 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
7966
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007967force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007968 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007969 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
7970 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7971
7972force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007973 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007974 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7975
7976force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007977 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007978 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7979
7980force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007981 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02007982 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
7983
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007984gid <gid>
7985 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
7986 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
7987 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
7988 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
7989 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7990
7991group <group>
7992 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
7993 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
7994 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
7995 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
7996 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
7997
7998id <id>
7999 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8000 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8001 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8002 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8003
8004interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008005 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8006 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8007 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8008 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8009 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8010 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8011 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008012
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008013level <level>
8014 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8015 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8016 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8017 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8018 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8019 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8020 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8021 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8022 counters).
8023 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8024 all counters).
8025
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008026maxconn <maxconn>
8027 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8028 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8029 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8030 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8031 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8032 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8033 eat all memory.
8034
8035mode <mode>
8036 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8037 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8038 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8039 UNIX sockets.
8040
8041mss <maxseg>
8042 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8043 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8044 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8045 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8046 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8047 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8048 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8049 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8050 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8051 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8052 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8053
8054name <name>
8055 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8056 page.
8057
8058nice <nice>
8059 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8060 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8061 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8062 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8063 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8064 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8065 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8066 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8067 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8068 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8069 one for an RDP socket.
8070
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008071no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008072 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008073 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008074 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008075 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8076 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008077
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008078no-tls-tickets
8079 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8080 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8081 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8082 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
8083
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008084no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008085 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008086 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008087 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8088 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8089 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008090
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008091no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008092 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008093 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008094 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8095 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8096 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008097
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008098no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008099 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008100 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008101 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8102 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8103 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008104
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008105npn <protocols>
8106 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8107 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8108 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8109 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008110 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8111 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008112
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008113ssl
8114 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008115 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008116 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8117 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8118 to deciphered contents.
8119
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008120strict-sni
8121 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8122 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8123 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8124 See the "crt" option for more information.
8125
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008126tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008127 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008128 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8129 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8130 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8131 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8132 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8133 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8134 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008135 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8136 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8137 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008138
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008139transparent
8140 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8141 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8142 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8143 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8144 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8145 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8146 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8147 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8148 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8149 so check for support with your vendor.
8150
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008151v4v6
8152 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8153 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8154 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8155 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008156 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008157
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008158v6only
8159 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8160 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8161 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008162 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8163 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008164
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008165uid <uid>
8166 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8167 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8168 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8169 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8170 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8171
8172user <user>
8173 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8174 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8175 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8176 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8177 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8178
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008179verify [none|optional|required]
8180 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8181 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8182 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8183 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8184 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008185 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8186 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8187 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8188 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008189
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020081905.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008191------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008192
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008193The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8194which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8195arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8196settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8197after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8198Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8199address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008200
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008201 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008202 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008203
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008204The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008205
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008206addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008207 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8208 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8209 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8210 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8211 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008212
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008213 Supported in default-server: No
8214
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008215agent-check
8216 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
8217 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP
8218 connection to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter" and reading
8219 an ASCII string. The string should have one of the following forms:
8220
8221 * An ASCII representation of an positive integer percentage.
8222 e.g. "75%"
8223
8224 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
8225 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
8226
8227 * The string "drain".
8228
8229 This will cause the weight of a server to be set to 0, and thus it will
8230 not accept any new connections other than those that are accepted via
8231 persistence.
8232
8233 * The string "down", optionally followed by a description string.
8234
8235 Mark the server as down and log the description string as the reason.
8236
8237 * The string "stopped", optionally followed by a description string.
8238
8239 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8240
8241 * The string "fail", optionally followed by a description string.
8242
8243 This currently has the same behaviour as "down".
8244
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008245 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8246 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
8247 parameter.
8248
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008249 Requires the ""agent-port" parameter to be set.
8250 See also the "agent-check" parameter.
8251
8252 Supported in default-server: No
8253
8254agent-inter <delay>
8255 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8256 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8257
8258 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8259 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8260 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8261 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8262 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8263 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8264 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8265 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8266 of backends use the same servers.
8267
8268 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8269
8270 Supported in default-server: Yes
8271
8272agent-port <port>
8273 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8274
8275 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8276
8277 Supported in default-server: Yes
8278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008279backup
8280 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8281 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8282 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8283 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8284 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8285 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008286
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008287 Supported in default-server: No
8288
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008289ca-file <cafile>
8290 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8291 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8292 server's certificate.
8293
8294 Supported in default-server: No
8295
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008296check
8297 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008298 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8299 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8300 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8301 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8302 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8303 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8304 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008305 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8306 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8307 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008308
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008309 Supported in default-server: No
8310
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008311check-send-proxy
8312 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8313 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8314 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8315 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8316 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8317 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8318 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8319
8320 Supported in default-server: No
8321
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008322check-ssl
8323 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8324 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8325 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8326 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008327 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008328 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8329 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8330 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8331 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8332
8333 Supported in default-server: No
8334
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008335ciphers <ciphers>
8336 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008337 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008338 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8339 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8340 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8341 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8342 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8343 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8344
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008345 Supported in default-server: No
8346
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008347cookie <value>
8348 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8349 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8350 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8351 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8352 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8353 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8354 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8355
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008356 Supported in default-server: No
8357
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008358crl-file <crlfile>
8359 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8360 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8361 to verify server's certificate.
8362
8363 Supported in default-server: No
8364
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008365crt <cert>
8366 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8367 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8368 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8369 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8370 certificate request.
8371
8372 Supported in default-server: No
8373
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008374disabled
8375 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8376 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8377 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8378 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8379 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8380
8381 Supported in default-server: No
8382
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008383error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008384 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8385 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8386 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008387
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008388 Supported in default-server: Yes
8389
8390 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008391
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008392fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008393 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8394 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8395 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8396
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008397 Supported in default-server: Yes
8398
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008399force-sslv3
8400 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8401 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8402 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8403
8404 Supported in default-server: No
8405
8406force-tlsv10
8407 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8408 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8409
8410 Supported in default-server: No
8411
8412force-tlsv11
8413 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8414 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8415
8416 Supported in default-server: No
8417
8418force-tlsv12
8419 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8420 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8421
8422 Supported in default-server: No
8423
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008424id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008425 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8426 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8427 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008428
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008429 Supported in default-server: No
8430
8431inter <delay>
8432fastinter <delay>
8433downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008434 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8435 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8436 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8437 between checks depending on the server state :
8438
8439 Server state | Interval used
8440 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8441 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8442 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8443 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8444 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8445 or yet unchecked. |
8446 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8447 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8448 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008449
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008450 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8451 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8452 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8453 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008454 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8455 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8456 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8457 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8458 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008459
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008460 Supported in default-server: Yes
8461
8462maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008463 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8464 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8465 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8466 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8467 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8468 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8469 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8470 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8471
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008472 Supported in default-server: Yes
8473
8474maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008475 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8476 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8477 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8478 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8479 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8480 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8481 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8482
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008483 Supported in default-server: Yes
8484
8485minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008486 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8487 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8488 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8489 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8490 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8491 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008492 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008493 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008494
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008495 Supported in default-server: Yes
8496
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008497no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008498 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8499 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008500 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008501
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008502 Supported in default-server: No
8503
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008504no-tls-tickets
8505 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8506 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8507 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8508 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
8509
8510 Supported in default-server: No
8511
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008512no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008513 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008514 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8515 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008516 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8517 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008518
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008519 Supported in default-server: No
8520
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008521no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008522 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008523 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8524 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008525 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8526 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008527
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008528 Supported in default-server: No
8529
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008530no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008531 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008532 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8533 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008534 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8535 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008536
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008537 Supported in default-server: No
8538
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09008539non-stick
8540 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
8541 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
8542 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
8543
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008544 Supported in default-server: No
8545
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008546observe <mode>
8547 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
8548 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
8549 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
8550 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
8551 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
8552 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01008553 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008554
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008555 Supported in default-server: No
8556
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008557 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
8558
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008559on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008560 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
8561 Currently, four modes are available:
8562 - fastinter: force fastinter
8563 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
8564 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
8565 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
8566 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
8567
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008568 Supported in default-server: Yes
8569
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008570 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
8571
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008572on-marked-down <action>
8573 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
8574 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008575 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
8576 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
8577 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
8578 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
8579 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
8580 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
8581 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
8582 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008583
8584 Actions are disabled by default
8585
8586 Supported in default-server: Yes
8587
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008588on-marked-up <action>
8589 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
8590 Currently one action is available:
8591 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
8592 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
8593 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
8594 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
8595 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
8596 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
8597 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
8598 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
8599
8600 Actions are disabled by default
8601
8602 Supported in default-server: Yes
8603
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008604port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008605 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
8606 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
8607 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
8608 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
8609 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
8610 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
8611
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008612 Supported in default-server: Yes
8613
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008614redir <prefix>
8615 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
8616 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
8617 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
8618 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
8619 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
8620 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
8621 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
8622 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008623 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008624 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
8625 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
8626 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
8627 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8628 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8629
8630 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8631
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008632 Supported in default-server: No
8633
8634rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008635 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8636 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8637 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8638
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008639 Supported in default-server: Yes
8640
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008641send-proxy
8642 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8643 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8644 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8645 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8646 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8647 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8648 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8649 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8650 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008651 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8652 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8653 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8654 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8655 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008656
8657 Supported in default-server: No
8658
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008659slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008660 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
8661 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
8662 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
8663 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
8664 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
8665 parameters :
8666
8667 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
8668 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
8669
8670 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
8671 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
8672 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
8673 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
8674
8675 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
8676 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
8677 seen as failed.
8678
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008679 Supported in default-server: Yes
8680
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008681source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008682source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008683source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008684 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
8685 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
8686 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
8687 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
8688
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008689 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
8690 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
8691 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
8692 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
8693 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
8694 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
8695 server.
8696
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008697 Supported in default-server: No
8698
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008699ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008700 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
8701 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
8702 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
8703 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
8704 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
8705 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008706 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008707
8708 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008709
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008710track [<proxy>/]<server>
8711 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
8712 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
8713 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
8714 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
8715 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
8716
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008717 Supported in default-server: No
8718
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008719verify [none|required]
8720 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01008721 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
8722 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
8723 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
8724 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02008725 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
8726 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
8727 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008728
8729 Supported in default-server: No
8730
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07008731verifyhost <hostname>
8732 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
8733 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
8734 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
8735 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
8736 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
8737 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
8738
8739 Supported in default-server: No
8740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008741weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008742 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
8743 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
8744 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02008745 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
8746 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
8747 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
8748 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
8749 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
8750 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008751
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008752 Supported in default-server: Yes
8753
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008754
87556. HTTP header manipulation
8756---------------------------
8757
8758In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
8759response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
8760request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
8761which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008762against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008763
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008764If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
8765to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
8766but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
8767HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
8768stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
8769because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
8770a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
8771still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02008772
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008773This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
8774in section 4.2 :
8775
8776 - reqadd <string>
8777 - reqallow <search>
8778 - reqiallow <search>
8779 - reqdel <search>
8780 - reqidel <search>
8781 - reqdeny <search>
8782 - reqideny <search>
8783 - reqpass <search>
8784 - reqipass <search>
8785 - reqrep <search> <replace>
8786 - reqirep <search> <replace>
8787 - reqtarpit <search>
8788 - reqitarpit <search>
8789 - rspadd <string>
8790 - rspdel <search>
8791 - rspidel <search>
8792 - rspdeny <search>
8793 - rspideny <search>
8794 - rsprep <search> <replace>
8795 - rspirep <search> <replace>
8796
8797With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
8798is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
8799parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
8800prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
8801Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
8802
8803 \t for a tab
8804 \r for a carriage return (CR)
8805 \n for a new line (LF)
8806 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
8807 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
8808 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
8809 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
8810 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
8811
8812The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
8813portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
8814above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
8815regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
88169 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
8817is very common to users of the "sed" program.
8818
8819The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
8820after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
8821
8822Notes related to these keywords :
8823---------------------------------
8824 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
8825 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
8826 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
8827
8828 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
8829 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
8830 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
8831
8832 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
8833 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
8834 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
8835 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
8836 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
8837
8838 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
8839 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
8840 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
8841 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
8842 useless headers before adding new ones.
8843
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008844 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008845 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
8846
8847 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
8848 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
8849 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
8850
8851 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
8852 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008853 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008854
8855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020088567. Using ACLs and fetching samples
8857----------------------------------
8858
8859Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
8860client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
8861The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
8862these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
8863but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
8864data called patterns.
8865
8866
88677.1. ACL basics
8868---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008869
8870The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
8871content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
8872from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
8873simple :
8874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008875 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008876 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008877 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
8878 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008880The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
8881adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008882
8883In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
8884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008885 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008886
8887This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
8888Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
8889and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008890an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
8891conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
8892as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
8893are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008894
8895ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
8896'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
8897which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
8898
8899There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
8900performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
8901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008902The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
8903specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
8904this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008905methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
8906ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008907
8908Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
8909 - boolean
8910 - integer (signed or unsigned)
8911 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
8912 - string
8913 - data block
8914
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01008915Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
8916converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
8917would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
8918The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
8919which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
8920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008921The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
8922 - boolean
8923 - integer or integer range
8924 - IP address / network
8925 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
8926 - regular expression
8927 - hex block
8928
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008929The following ACL flags are currently supported :
8930
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02008931 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
8932 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008933 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01008934 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01008935 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01008936 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008937 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
8938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008939The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
8940read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
8941if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
8942lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
8943will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
8944beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
8945a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
8946lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
8947exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
8948
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01008949The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
8950parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
8951ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
8952a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
8953check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
8954
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01008955The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
8956socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
8957file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
8958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008959Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
8960loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
8961
8962 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
8963
8964In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
8965the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
8966case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
8967as well.
8968
8969The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
8970sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
8971do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
8972methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
8973is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
8974obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
8975followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
8976default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
8977that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
8978string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
8979
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01008980The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
8981By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
8982string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
8983resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
8984server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
8985waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
8986flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
8987function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
8988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008989There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
8990sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
8991be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008992
8993 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
8994 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008995 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
8996 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
8997 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
8998 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02008999
9000 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9001 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009002 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009003
9004 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009005 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009006
9007 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009008 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009009
9010 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9011 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9012
9013 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9014 binary or string samples.
9015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009016 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9017 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009019 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9020 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9021 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009023 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9024 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009026 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9027 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009029 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9030 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009032 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9033 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009034 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009036 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9037 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9038 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009039
9040For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9041request, it is possible to do :
9042
9043 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9044
9045In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9046buffer, one would use the following acl :
9047
9048 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9049
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009050On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9051possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9052
9053 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009055All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9056criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9057method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9058to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9059criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9060the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009062If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009063the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9064For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009066 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9067 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9068 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9069 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009070
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009071
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009072The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample types
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009073and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9074combination the name of the matching method to be used, prefixed with "*" when
9075the method is implicit and will work by default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009077 +-------------------------------------------------+
9078 | Input sample type |
9079 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9080 | pattern type | boolean | integer | IP | string | binary |
9081 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9082 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9083 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009084 | none (boolean value) | *bool | bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009085 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009086 | integer (value) | int | *int | int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009087 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009088 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009089 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009090 | IP address | | | *ip | ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009091 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009092 | exact string | str | str | str | str | str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009093 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009094 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009095 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009096 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009097 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009098 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009099 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009100 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009101 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009102 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009103 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009104 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009105 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9106 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9107 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009108
9109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020091107.1.1. Matching booleans
9111------------------------
9112
9113In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9114Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9115When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9116that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9117
9118Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9119return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9120"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9121
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020091237.1.2. Matching integers
9124------------------------
9125
9126Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9127enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9128to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9129
9130Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9131matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9132lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009133
9134For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9135unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9136representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9137
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009138As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9139two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9140instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9141ranges and operators.
9142
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009143For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009144operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9145Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9146of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009147
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009148Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009149
9150 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9151 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9152 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9153 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9154 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9155
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009156For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009157
9158 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9159
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009160This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9161
9162 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9163
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020091657.1.3. Matching strings
9166-----------------------
9167
9168String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9169different forms :
9170
9171 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9172 patterns ;
9173
9174 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9175 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9176
9177 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9178 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9179
9180 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9181 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9182
9183 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9184 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9185 matches.
9186
9187 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9188 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9189 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009190
9191String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9192exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9193characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9194string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9195to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009196before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009197
9198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020091997.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9200---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009201
9202Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9203they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9204possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9205passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9206the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009207the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9208match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009209
9210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020092117.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9212-------------------------------------
9213
9214It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9215not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9216a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9217to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9218digits may be used upper or lower case.
9219
9220Example :
9221 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9222 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9223
9224
92257.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9226---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009227
9228IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9229netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9230within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009231host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009232difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9233at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9234does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9235parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009236
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009237IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9238Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9239trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9240IPv6 patterns.
9241
9242HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9243following situations :
9244 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9245 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9246 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9247 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9248 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9249 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9250 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9251 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9252 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9253 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009255
92567.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9257----------------------------------
9258
9259Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9260combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9261
9262 - AND (implicit)
9263 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9264 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009266A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009268 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009270Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9271indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009273For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9274"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9275requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9276is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9277
9278 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9279 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9280 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9281 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9282
9283To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9284and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9285
9286 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9287 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9288 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9289 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9290
9291 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9292 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9293 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9294 use_backend www if host_www
9295
9296It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9297expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9298be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9299the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9300
9301 The following rule :
9302
9303 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9304 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9305
9306 Can also be written that way :
9307
9308 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9309
9310It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9311to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9312simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9313sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9314good use is the following :
9315
9316 With named ACLs :
9317
9318 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9319 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9320 monitor fail if site_dead
9321
9322 With anonymous ACLs :
9323
9324 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9325
9326See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9327
9328
93297.3. Fetching samples
9330---------------------
9331
9332Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9333against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9334sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9335ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9336of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9337available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9338
9339This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9340Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9341compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9342deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9343
9344The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9345matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9346method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9347indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9348
9349As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9350when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9351mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9352the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9353ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9354
9355Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9356multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9357when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9358incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9359are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9360is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9361all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9362
9363Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9364 - name
9365 - name(arg1)
9366 - name(arg1,arg2)
9367
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009368
93697.3.1. Converters
9370-----------------
9371
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009372Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9373of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9374is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9375was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9376has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9377unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9378
9379These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9380sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9381the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9382support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009384The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009385
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009386lower
9387 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
9388 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9389 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009390
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009391upper
9392 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
9393 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9394 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009395
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009396hex
9397 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
9398 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
9399 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
9400 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009401
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009402ipmask(<mask>)
9403 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
9404 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
9405 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
9406 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009407
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009408http_date([<offset>])
9409 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
9410 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
9411 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
9412 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
9413 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
9414 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009415
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009416language(<value>[,<default>])
9417 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
9418 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
9419 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
9420 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
9421 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
9422 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
9423 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
9424 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
9425 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
9426 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
9427 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
9428 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009429
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009430 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009431
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009432 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
9433 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009434
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009435 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
9436 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
9437 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
9438 use_backend spanish if es
9439 use_backend french if fr
9440 use_backend english if en
9441 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009442
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009443map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9444map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9445map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9446 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
9447 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
9448 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
9449 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
9450 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
9451 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
9452 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
9453 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009454
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009455 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
9456 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
9457 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009458
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009459 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
9460 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009461
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009462 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
9463 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9464 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
9465 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9466 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
9467 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9468 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
9469 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9470 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
9471 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9472 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
9473 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9474 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
9475 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9476 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
9477 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9478 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
9479 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009480
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009481 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
9482 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
9483 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
9484 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
9485 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009486
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009487 Example :
9488
9489 # this is a comment and is ignored
9490 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
9491 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
9492 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
9493 | | | `---------- value
9494 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
9495 | `---------------------------- key
9496 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
9497
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009498
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020094997.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009500--------------------------------------------
9501
9502A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
9503not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
9504"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
9505The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
9506
9507always_false : boolean
9508 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9509 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9510
9511always_true : boolean
9512 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9513 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9514
9515avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009516 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009517 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
9518 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
9519 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
9520 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
9521 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
9522 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
9523 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
9524 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
9525 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
9526 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
9527 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
9528 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
9529 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01009530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009531be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009532 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
9533 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
9534 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
9535 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
9536 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009538be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
9539 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9540 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9541 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
9542 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
9543 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
9544 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009545
9546 Example :
9547 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
9548 backend dynamic
9549 mode http
9550 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
9551 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009553connslots([<backend>]) : integer
9554 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009555 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009556 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
9557 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05009558
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009559 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009560 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009561 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
9562
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009563 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
9564 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009565
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009566 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009567 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009568 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009569 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
9570 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009571 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009572 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009573
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009574 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
9575 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009576 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009577 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009578
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009579date([<offset>]) : integer
9580 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
9581 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
9582 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
9583 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009584 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
9585
9586 Example :
9587
9588 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
9589 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009590
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02009591env(<name>) : string
9592 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
9593 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
9594 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
9595 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
9596 certain way.
9597
9598 Examples :
9599 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
9600 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
9601
9602 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
9603 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
9604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009605fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
9606 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009607 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
9608 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009609 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
9610 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
9611 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
9612 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
9613 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009615fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
9616 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9617 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9618 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
9619 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
9620 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
9621 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
9622 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
9623 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009624
9625 Example :
9626 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
9627 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
9628 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
9629 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
9630 frontend mail
9631 bind :25
9632 mode tcp
9633 maxconn 100
9634 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
9635 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
9636 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
9637 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009639nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
9640 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
9641 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
9642 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009643 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
9644 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
9645 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009647queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009648 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
9649 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
9650 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009651 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
9652 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
9653 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
9654 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
9655 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
9656
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +01009657rand([<range>]) : integer
9658 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
9659 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
9660 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
9661 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
9662 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
9663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009664srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9665 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9666 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
9667 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
9668 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
9669 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
9670 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
9671 methods.
9672
9673srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
9674 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
9675 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
9676 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
9677 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
9678 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
9679 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
9680 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
9681
9682srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
9683 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9684 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009685 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009686 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
9687 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
9688 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
9689 overloading servers).
9690
9691 Example :
9692 # Redirect to a separate back
9693 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
9694 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
9695 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
9696
9697table_avl([<table>]) : integer
9698 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
9699 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
9700
9701table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9702 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
9703 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
9704 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
9705
9706
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020097077.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009708----------------------------------
9709
9710The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
9711closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
9712methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
9713sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
9714TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009715the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
9716counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
9717"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009718argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
9719the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
9720this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009721
9722be_id : integer
9723 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
9724 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
9725
9726dst : ip
9727 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
9728 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
9729 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
9730 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
9731 RFC 4291.
9732
9733dst_conn : integer
9734 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
9735 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
9736 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
9737 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
9738 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
9739 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
9740 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
9741 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009743dst_port : integer
9744 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
9745 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
9746 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
9747 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
9748 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
9749 an HTTP header.
9750
9751fe_id : integer
9752 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
9753 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
9754 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
9755
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009756sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009757sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9758sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9759sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009760 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
9761 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9762 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
9763
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009764sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009765sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9766sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9767sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009768 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
9769 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
9770 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
9771
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009772sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009773sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9774sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9775sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009776 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
9777 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009778 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
9779 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
9780 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009781
9782 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9783 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009784 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9785 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
9786 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009787 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9788 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9789
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009790sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009791sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9792sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9793sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009794 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
9795 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
9796
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009797sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009798sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9799sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
9800sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009801 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9802 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
9803 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
9804
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009805sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009806sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9807sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9808sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009809 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
9810 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
9811 See also src_conn_rate.
9812
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009813sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009814sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9815sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9816sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009817 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009818 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009819
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009820sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009821sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9822sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
9823sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009824 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9825 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
9826 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009827 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
9828 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
9829 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009830
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009831sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009832sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9833sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9834sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009835 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
9836 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
9837 See also src_http_err_cnt.
9838
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009839sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009840sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9841sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
9842sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009843 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
9844 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
9845 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
9846 src_http_err_rate.
9847
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009848sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009849sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9850sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9851sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009852 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9853 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9854 src_http_req_cnt.
9855
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009856sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009857sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9858sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
9859sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009860 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
9861 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
9862 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
9863 src_http_req_rate.
9864
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009865sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009866sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9867sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9868sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009869 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009870 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
9871 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
9872 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
9873 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009874
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009875 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
9876 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009877 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9878
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009879sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009880sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9881sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
9882sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009883 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
9884 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9885 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9886 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
9887
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009888sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009889sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9890sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
9891sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009892 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
9893 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
9894 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
9895 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
9896
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009897sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009898sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9899sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
9900sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009901 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
9902 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
9903 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
9904 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009905 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009906 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
9907
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009908sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009909sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9910sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
9911sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009912 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
9913 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
9914 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
9915 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
9916 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009917 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009918
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009919sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009920sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9921sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
9922sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +02009923 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
9924 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
9925 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
9926
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +02009927sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +02009928sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9929sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
9930sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009931 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
9932 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009933 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009934 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
9935 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009936 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
9937 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
9938 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +01009939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009940so_id : integer
9941 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
9942 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
9943 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009945src : ip
9946 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
9947 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
9948 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
9949 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
9950 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
9951 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
9952 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009953
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009954 Example:
9955 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
9956 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
9957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009958src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
9959 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
9960 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
9961 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009962 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009964src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
9965 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
9966 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009967 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009968 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009970src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
9971 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
9972 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
9973 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
9974 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
9975 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
9976 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009977
9978 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
9979 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
9980 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
9981 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +01009982 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02009983 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
9984 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
9985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009986src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009987 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009988 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009989 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009990 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009992src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009993 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009994 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
9995 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +02009996 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009998src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
9999 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10000 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10001 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010002 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010004src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010005 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010006 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010007 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010008 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010010src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010011 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010012 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010013 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10014 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010015 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10016 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10017 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010019src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10020 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10021 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010022 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010023 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010024 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010026src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10027 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10028 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10029 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10030 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010031 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010033src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10034 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10035 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10036 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010037 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010039src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10040 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10041 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10042 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010043 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010044 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010046src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10047 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10048 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10049 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010050 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010051 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10052 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010053
10054 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010055 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010056 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010058src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10059 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
10060 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10061 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
10062 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010063 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
10064 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010066src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10067 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
10068 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010069 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
10070 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010071 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010073src_port : integer
10074 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10075 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10076 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10077 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010079src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10080 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010081 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10082 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10083 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010084 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010086src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10087 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10088 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10089 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10090 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010091 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010093src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10094 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10095 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10096 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10097 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10098 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10099 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10100 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10101 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010102
10103 Example :
10104 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10105 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10106 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10107 listen ssh
10108 bind :22
10109 mode tcp
10110 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010111 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010112 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010113 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010115srv_id : integer
10116 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10117 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10118 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010119
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010120
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200101217.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010122----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010124The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10125closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10126when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10127usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010128future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010130ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10131 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10132 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10133 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10134 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10135 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010137ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10138 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10139 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10140 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10141 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010143ssl_c_err : integer
10144 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10145 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10146 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10147 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10148 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010150ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10151 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10152 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10153 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10154 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10155 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10156 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10157 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10158 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010160 ACL derivatives :
10161 ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010163ssl_c_key_alg : string
10164 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10165 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10166 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010168 ACL derivatives :
10169 ssl_c_key_alg : exact string match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020010170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010171ssl_c_notafter : string
10172 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10173 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10174 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010176 ACL derivatives :
10177 ssl_c_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010179ssl_c_notbefore : string
10180 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10181 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10182 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010184 ACL derivatives :
10185 ssl_c_notbefore : exact string match
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010187ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10188 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10189 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10190 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10191 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10192 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10193 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10194 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10195 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010197 ACL derivatives :
10198 ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010200ssl_c_serial : binary
10201 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10202 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10203 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010205 ACL derivatives :
10206 ssl_c_serial : hex block match
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010208ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10209 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10210 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10211 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010213ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10214 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10215 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10216 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010218 ACL derivatives :
10219 ssl_c_sig_alg : exact string match
10220
10221ssl_c_used : boolean
10222 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10223 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010225ssl_c_verify : integer
10226 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10227 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10228 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10229 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010231ssl_c_version : integer
10232 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10233 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010235ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10236 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10237 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10238 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10239 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010240 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010241 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10242 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10243 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010245 ACL derivatives :
10246 ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +020010247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010248ssl_f_key_alg : string
10249 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10250 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10251 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010253 ACL derivatives :
10254 ssl_f_key_alg : exact string match
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010256ssl_f_notafter : string
10257 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10258 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10259 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010261 ACL derivatives :
10262 ssl_f_notafter : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +020010263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010264ssl_f_notbefore : string
10265 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10266 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10267 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010269 ACL derivatives :
10270 ssl_f_notbefore : exact string match
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010272ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10273 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10274 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10275 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10276 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10277 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10278 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10279 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10280 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010282 ACL derivatives :
10283 ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010285ssl_f_serial : binary
10286 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10287 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10288 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010290 ACL derivatives :
10291 ssl_f_serial : hex block match
Willy Tarreau8d598402012-10-22 17:58:39 +020010292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010293ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10294 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10295 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10296 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010298 ACL derivatives :
10299 ssl_f_sig_alg : exact string match
Emeric Bruna7359fd2012-10-17 15:03:11 +020010300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010301ssl_f_version : integer
10302 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10303 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10304
10305ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010306 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10307 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10308 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010310 Example :
10311 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10312 listen http-https
10313 bind :80
10314 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10315 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10316
10317ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10318 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10319 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10320
10321ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010322 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010323 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10324 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10325 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10326 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10327 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10328 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10329 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10330 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10331
10332 ACL derivatives :
10333 ssl_fc_alpn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010335ssl_fc_cipher : string
10336 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10337 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010339 ACL derivatives :
10340 ssl_fc_cipher : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010342ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010343 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10344 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010345 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10346 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10347 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10348 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010350ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10351 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010352 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10353 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10354 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10355 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010357ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010358 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010359 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10360 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10361 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10362 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10363 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10364 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10365 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010367 ACL derivatives :
10368 ssl_fc_npn : exact string match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010370ssl_fc_protocol : string
10371 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10372 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010374 ACL derivatives :
10375 ssl_fc_protocol : exact string match
10376
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010377ssl_fc_unique_id : string
10378 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10379 returns a base64 encoded string containing the TLS unique ID as defined
10380 in RFC5929 section 3.
10381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010382ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10383 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10384 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10385 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10386 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010388ssl_fc_sni : string
10389 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10390 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10391 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10392 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10393 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10394
10395 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10396 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10397 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010398 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10399 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010401 ACL derivatives :
10402 ssl_fc_sni : exact string match
10403 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10404 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010406ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10407 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10408 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010409
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010410
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200104117.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010412------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010414Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10415sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10416only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10417For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10418be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10419can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10420sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10421for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10422content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010424payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10425 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10426 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10427 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010429payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10430 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10431 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10432 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010434req.len : integer
10435req_len : integer (deprecated)
10436 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10437 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10438 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10439 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10440 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10441 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10442 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10443 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010445req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10446 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010447 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10448 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10449 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10450 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010452 ACL alternatives :
10453 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010455req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10456 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10457 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10458 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
10459 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010461 ACL alternatives :
10462 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010464 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010466req.proto_http : boolean
10467req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
10468 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
10469 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
10470 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
10471 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
10472 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
10473 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
10474 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010476 Example:
10477 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10478 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10479 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010480 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010482req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
10483rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10484 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
10485 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
10486 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
10487 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
10488 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
10489 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
10490 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010492 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
10493 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
10494 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
10495 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
10496 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
10497 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010499 ACL derivatives :
10500 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010502 Example :
10503 listen tse-farm
10504 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
10505 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10506 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10507 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10508 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10509 persist rdp-cookie
10510 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
10511 # This is only useful makes sense if
10512 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
10513 stick-table type string size 204800
10514 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
10515 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10516 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010518 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
10519 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010521req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
10522rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
10523 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
10524 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
10525 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
10526 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010528 ACL derivatives :
10529 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010531req.ssl_hello_type : integer
10532req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10533 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10534 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
10535 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10536 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10537 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
10538 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10539 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010541req.ssl_sni : string
10542req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
10543 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
10544 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
10545 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
10546 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10547 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10548 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
10549 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
10550 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
10551 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
10552 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
10553 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
10554 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010556 ACL derivatives :
10557 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010559 Examples :
10560 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
10561 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10562 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
10563 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
10564 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010566res.ssl_hello_type : integer
10567rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10568 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10569 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
10570 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10571 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10572 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
10573 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10574 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020010575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010576req.ssl_ver : integer
10577req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
10578 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
10579 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
10580 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
10581 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
10582 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10583 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10584 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
10585 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
10586 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010588 ACL derivatives :
10589 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010590
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020010591res.len : integer
10592 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10593 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10594 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10595 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10596 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10597 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10598 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
10599 content inspection.
10600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010601res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10602 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010603 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10604 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10605 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10606 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010608res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10609 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10610 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10611 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
10612 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010614 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010616wait_end : boolean
10617 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
10618 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
10619 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
10620 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
10621 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
10622 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
10623 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
10624 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010626 Examples :
10627 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
10628 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
10629 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010631 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
10632 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10633 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
10634 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
10635 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
10636 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
10637 tcp-request content reject
10638
10639
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200106407.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010641--------------------------------------
10642
10643It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
10644This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
10645data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
10646its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
10647HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
10648content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
10649to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
10650more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
10651response are indexed.
10652
10653base : string
10654 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
10655 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
10656 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
10657 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
10658 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
10659 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
10660 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
10661 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
10662
10663 ACL derivatives :
10664 base : exact string match
10665 base_beg : prefix match
10666 base_dir : subdir match
10667 base_dom : domain match
10668 base_end : suffix match
10669 base_len : length match
10670 base_reg : regex match
10671 base_sub : substring match
10672
10673base32 : integer
10674 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
10675 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
10676 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
10677 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
10678
10679base32+src : binary
10680 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
10681 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
10682 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
10683 per-URL counters.
10684
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010010685capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
10686 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
10687 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
10688 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
10689
10690capture.req.method : string
10691 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
10692 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
10693 because it's allocated.
10694
10695capture.req.uri : string
10696 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
10697 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
10698 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
10699 allocated.
10700
10701capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
10702 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
10703 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
10704 The first entry is an index of 0.
10705 See also: "capture response header"
10706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010707req.cook([<name>]) : string
10708cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10709 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10710 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10711 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
10712 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
10713 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
10714 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
10715 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
10716 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
10717
10718 ACL derivatives :
10719 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
10720 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
10721 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
10722 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
10723 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
10724 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
10725 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
10726 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010728req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10729cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10730 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10731 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010733req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10734cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10735 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10736 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
10737 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
10738 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010740cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10741 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
10742 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
10743 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
10744 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
10745 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
10746 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
10747 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
10748 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
10749 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
10750 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010752hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10753 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
10754 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
10755 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
10756 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010757 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010759req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
10760 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10761 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10762 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10763 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10764 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10765 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
10766 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
10767 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010769req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10770 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10771 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10772 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10773 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010775req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10776 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
10777 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
10778 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10779 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10780 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10781 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
10782 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
10783 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
10784 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
10785 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
10786 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010788 ACL derivatives :
10789 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10790 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10791 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10792 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10793 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10794 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10795 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10796 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10797
10798req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10799hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
10800 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
10801 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
10802 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
10803 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
10804 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
10805 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
10806 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
10807 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
10808 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
10809
10810req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10811hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10812 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
10813 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
10814 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
10815 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10816 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10817 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10818 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
10819 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
10820
10821req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10822hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10823 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
10824 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
10825 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
10826 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
10827 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
10828 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
10829 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
10830
10831http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
10832 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
10833 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
10834 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10835 basic auth is supported.
10836
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010010837http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
10838 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
10839 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
10840 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
10841 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010842 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
10843 basic auth is supported.
10844
10845 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010010846 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
10847 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
10848 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
10849 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010850
10851http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010852 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
10853 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010854 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
10855 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020010856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010857method : integer + string
10858 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
10859 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
10860 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
10861 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
10862 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
10863 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
10864 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010866 ACL derivatives :
10867 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010869 Example :
10870 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
10871 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
10872 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010874path : string
10875 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
10876 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
10877 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
10878 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
10879 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
10880 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
10881 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010883 ACL derivatives :
10884 path : exact string match
10885 path_beg : prefix match
10886 path_dir : subdir match
10887 path_dom : domain match
10888 path_end : suffix match
10889 path_len : length match
10890 path_reg : regex match
10891 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010893req.ver : string
10894req_ver : string (deprecated)
10895 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
10896 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
10897 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010899 ACL derivatives :
10900 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020010901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010902res.comp : boolean
10903 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
10904 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
10905 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010907res.comp_algo : string
10908 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
10909 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
10910 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010912res.cook([<name>]) : string
10913scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10914 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10915 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
10916 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010918 ACL derivatives :
10919 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020010920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010921res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10922scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10923 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
10924 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
10925 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010927res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
10928scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10929 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
10930 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
10931 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010933res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10934 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10935 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10936 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10937 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10938 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
10939 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
10940 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
10941 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
10942 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010944res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10945 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10946 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10947 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
10948 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
10949 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010951res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
10952shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
10953 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
10954 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
10955 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
10956 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
10957 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
10958 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
10959 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
10960 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010962 ACL derivatives :
10963 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
10964 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
10965 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
10966 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
10967 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
10968 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
10969 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
10970 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
10971
10972res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
10973shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
10974 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
10975 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
10976 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
10977 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
10978 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010980res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
10981shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
10982 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
10983 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
10984 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
10985 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
10986 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
10987 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010989res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
10990shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
10991 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
10992 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
10993 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
10994 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10995 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
10996 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010010997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010998res.ver : string
10999resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11000 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11001 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011003 ACL derivatives :
11004 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011006set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11007 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11008 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11009 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11010 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011012 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11013 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011015 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011017status : integer
11018 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11019 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11020 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011022url : string
11023 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11024 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11025 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11026 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11027 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11028 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11029 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011031 ACL derivatives :
11032 url : exact string match
11033 url_beg : prefix match
11034 url_dir : subdir match
11035 url_dom : domain match
11036 url_end : suffix match
11037 url_len : length match
11038 url_reg : regex match
11039 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011041url_ip : ip
11042 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11043 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11044 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11045 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11046 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11047 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11048 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011050url_port : integer
11051 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11052 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11053 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11054 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011056urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11057url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11058 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11059 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11060 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11061 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11062 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11063 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11064 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11065 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11066 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011068 ACL derivatives :
11069 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11070 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11071 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11072 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11073 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11074 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11075 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11076 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011077
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011079 Example :
11080 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11081 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11082 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11083 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011085urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11086 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11087 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11088 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011089
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200110917.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011092---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011093
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011094Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11095every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011096order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011097
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011098ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11099---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011100FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011101HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011102HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11103HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011104HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11105HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11106HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11107HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11108LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011109METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11110METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11111METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11112METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11113METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11114METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011115RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011116REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011117TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011118WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11119---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011120
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011121
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111228. Logging
11123----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011124
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011125One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11126provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11127very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11128provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11129state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011130to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011131headers.
11132
11133In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11134about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11135send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11136
11137 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11138 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11139 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11140 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11141 at the termination.
11142
11143The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11144allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11145as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11146while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11147real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11148delay.
11149
11150
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111518.1. Log levels
11152---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011153
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011154TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011155source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011156HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11157in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11158track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11159syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11160about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011161
11162
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111638.2. Log formats
11164----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011165
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011166HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011167and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11168slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11169options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011170
11171 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11172 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11173 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11174 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11175 extents.
11176
11177 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11178 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11179 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11180 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11181 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11182
11183 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11184 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11185 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11186 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11187 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11188
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011189 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11190 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11191 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11192 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11193
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011194 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11195
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011196Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11197specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11198field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11199servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11200always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11201identifier.
11202
11203Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11204 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11205 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11206 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11207 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11208
11209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112108.2.1. Default log format
11211-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011212
11213This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11214as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11215format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11216
11217 Example :
11218 listen www
11219 mode http
11220 log global
11221 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11222
11223 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11224 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11225 (www/HTTP)
11226
11227 Field Format Extract from the example above
11228 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11229 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11230 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11231 4 'to' to
11232 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11233 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11234
11235Detailed fields description :
11236 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11237 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11238 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11239 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11240 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11241 and processed the connection.
11242 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11243
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011244In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11245"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11246connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11247
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011248It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11249will eventually disappear.
11250
11251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112528.2.2. TCP log format
11253---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011254
11255The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11256is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11257information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11258counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11259emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11260environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11261the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11262sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011263specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11264not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11265fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11266marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011267
11268 Example :
11269 frontend fnt
11270 mode tcp
11271 option tcplog
11272 log global
11273 default_backend bck
11274
11275 backend bck
11276 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11277
11278 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11279 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11280 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11281
11282 Field Format Extract from the example above
11283 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11284 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11285 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11286 4 frontend_name fnt
11287 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11288 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11289 7 bytes_read* 212
11290 8 termination_state --
11291 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11292 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11293
11294Detailed fields description :
11295 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011296 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11297 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11298 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11299 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11300 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011301
11302 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011303 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11304 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11305 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011306
11307 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11308 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11309 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11310 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11311
11312 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11313 and processed the connection.
11314
11315 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11316 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11317 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11318 applications.
11319
11320 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11321 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11322 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11323 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11324 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11325
11326 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11327 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11328 See "Timers" below for more details.
11329
11330 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11331 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11332 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11333 "Timers" below for more details.
11334
11335 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011336 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011337 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11338 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11339 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11340 details.
11341
11342 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11343 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11344 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11345 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11346 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11347
11348 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11349 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11350 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11351 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11352 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11353 for more details.
11354
11355 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011356 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011357 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11358 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11359 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011360 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011361
11362 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11363 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11364 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11365 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11366 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11367 caused by a denial of service attack.
11368
11369 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11370 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11371 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11372 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11373 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11374 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11375 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11376 denial of service attack.
11377
11378 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11379 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11380 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11381 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11382 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11383 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11384 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11385 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11386 be processed than on other servers.
11387
11388 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11389 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11390 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11391 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11392 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11393 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11394 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11395 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11396 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11397 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11398 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11399 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11400 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11401
11402 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11403 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11404 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11405 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11406 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11407 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11408 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11409 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11410
11411 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11412 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11413 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11414 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11415 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11416 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11417 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11418 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11419 occurs.
11420
11421
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114228.2.3. HTTP log format
11423----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011424
11425The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11426is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11427the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11428are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11429emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11430generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11431"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11432which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011433frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
11434is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011435
11436Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
11437slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
11438with a star ('*') after the field name below.
11439
11440 Example :
11441 frontend http-in
11442 mode http
11443 option httplog
11444 log global
11445 default_backend bck
11446
11447 backend static
11448 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11449
11450 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
11451 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
11452 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011453 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011454
11455 Field Format Extract from the example above
11456 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
11457 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
11458 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
11459 4 frontend_name http-in
11460 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
11461 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
11462 7 status_code 200
11463 8 bytes_read* 2750
11464 9 captured_request_cookie -
11465 10 captured_response_cookie -
11466 11 termination_state ----
11467 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
11468 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11469 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
11470 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
11471 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011472
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011473
11474Detailed fields description :
11475 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011476 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11477 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11478 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11479 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11480 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011481
11482 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011483 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11484 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11485 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011486
11487 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
11488 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
11489 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
11490 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
11491 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
11492
11493 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11494 and processed the connection.
11495
11496 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11497 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11498 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
11499
11500 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11501 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11502 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11503 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
11504 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
11505 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
11506
11507 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
11508 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
11509 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
11510 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
11511 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
11512 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
11513
11514 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11515 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11516 See "Timers" below for more details.
11517
11518 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11519 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11520 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
11521 below for more details.
11522
11523 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
11524 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
11525 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
11526 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
11527 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
11528 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
11529 for more details.
11530
11531 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011532 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011533 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11534 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11535 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11536 details.
11537
11538 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
11539 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
11540 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
11541
11542 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
11543 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
11544 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
11545 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
11546 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
11547 overflowing.
11548
11549 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
11550 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
11551 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
11552 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
11553 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
11554 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
11555 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
11556 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11557
11558 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
11559 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
11560 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
11561 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
11562 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
11563 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
11564 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
11565 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11566
11567 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11568 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11569 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
11570 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
11571 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
11572 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
11573 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
11574
11575 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011576 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011577 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
11578 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
11579 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011580 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011581 system.
11582
11583 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11584 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11585 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11586 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11587 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11588 caused by a denial of service attack.
11589
11590 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11591 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11592 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11593 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11594 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11595 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11596 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11597 denial of service attack.
11598
11599 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11600 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11601 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11602 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11603 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11604 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11605 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11606 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
11607 processed than on other servers.
11608
11609 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11610 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11611 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11612 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11613 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11614 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11615 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11616 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11617 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11618 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11619 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11620 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11621 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11622
11623 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11624 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11625 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11626 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11627 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11628 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11629 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11630 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11631
11632 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11633 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11634 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11635 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11636 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11637 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11638 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11639 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11640 occurs.
11641
11642 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
11643 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
11644 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
11645 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
11646 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
11647 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
11648 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
11649 cookies" below for more details.
11650
11651 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
11652 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
11653 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
11654 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
11655 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
11656 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
11657 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
11658 and cookies" below for more details.
11659
11660 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
11661 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
11662 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
11663 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
11664 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
11665 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
11666 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
11667 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
11668
11669
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200116708.2.4. Custom log format
11671------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011672
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011673The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011674mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011675
11676HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
11677Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
11678separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
11679prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
11680
11681Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
11682variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
11683string formats ("Q").
11684
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011685If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011686as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010011687less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
11688the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
11689
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011690Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011691In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010011692in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011693
11694Flags are :
11695 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011696 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011697
11698 Example:
11699
11700 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
11701 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
11702
11703At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
11704
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011705 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
11706 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011707
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011708the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011709
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011710 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011711 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011712 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011713
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011714and the default TCP format is defined this way :
11715
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011716 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011717 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
11718
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011719Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
11720
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011721 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011722 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011723 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
11724 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
11725 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011726 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
11727 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
11728 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011729 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011730 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011731 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011732 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011733 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080011734 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011735 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
11736 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011737 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011738 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
11739 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011740 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011741 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
11742 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011743 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11744 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
11745 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011746 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011747 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
11748 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011749 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011750 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
11751 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
11752 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020011753 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011754 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
11755 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
11756 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
11757 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011758 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020011759 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011760 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011761 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010011762 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011763 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011764 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
11765 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
11766 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011767 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011768 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
11769 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010011770 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011771 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011772 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010011773 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011774
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020011775 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011776
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010011777
117788.2.5. Error log format
11779-----------------------
11780
11781When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
11782protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
11783By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
11784"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
11785will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
11786logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
11787
11788The format looks like this :
11789
11790 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
11791 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
11792 Connection error during SSL handshake
11793
11794 Field Format Extract from the example above
11795 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
11796 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
11797 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
11798 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
11799 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
11800
11801These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
11802failures.
11803
11804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118058.3. Advanced logging options
11806-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011807
11808Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
11809just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
11810options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
11811for more information about their usage.
11812
11813
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118148.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
11815------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011816
11817It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
11818haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
11819commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
11820monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
11821ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
11822
11823 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
11824 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
11825 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
11826 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
11827
11828 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
11829 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
11830 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011831 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011832 such as other load-balancers.
11833
11834 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
11835 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
11836 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
11837
11838
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118398.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
11840----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011841
11842The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
11843what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
11844or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
11845"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
11846just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
11847log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
11848after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
11849is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
11850with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
11851with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
11852
11853
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118548.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
11855------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011856
11857Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
11858for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
11859"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
11860retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
11861raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
11862a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
11863file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
11864you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
11865"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
11866
11867
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118688.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
11869--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011870
11871Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
11872multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
11873them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
11874"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
11875logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
11876error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
11877and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
11878too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
11879useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
11880alternative.
11881
11882
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118838.4. Timing events
11884------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011885
11886Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
11887reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
11888the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
11889frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
11890mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
11891
11892 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
11893 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
11894 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
11895 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
11896 the client closes prematurely or times out.
11897
11898 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
11899 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
11900 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
11901 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
11902 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
11903
11904 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
11905 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
11906 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
11907 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
11908 connection never established.
11909
11910 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
11911 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
11912 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
11913 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
11914 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
11915 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
11916 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
11917 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
11918 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
11919 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
11920 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
11921
11922 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
11923 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
11924 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
11925 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011926 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011927
11928 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
11929
11930 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
11931 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
11932 negative.
11933
11934These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
11935protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
11936that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011937due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011938close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
11939session has been aborted on timeout.
11940
11941Most common cases :
11942
11943 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11944 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
11945 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
11946 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
11947 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
11948 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
11949 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
11950 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
11951 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020011952 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
11953 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
11954 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011955
11956 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
11957 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
11958 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
11959 of ms on remote networks.
11960
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011961 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
11962 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
11963 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011964
11965 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
11966 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
11967 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
11968 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
11969 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
11970 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
11971 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
11972 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
11973 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
11974 to the server until another one is released.
11975
11976Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
11977
11978 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
11979 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
11980 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
11981
11982 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
11983 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
11984 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
11985
11986 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
11987 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
11988 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
11989 flags.
11990
11991 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
11992 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
11993 Check the session termination flags, then check the
11994 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
11995 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
11996 the client connection was maintained open.
11997
11998 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011999 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012000 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12001 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12002
12003
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200120048.5. Session state at disconnection
12005-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012006
12007TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12008"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
120092-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12010each of which has a special meaning :
12011
12012 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12013 session to terminate :
12014
12015 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12016
12017 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12018 server explicitly refused it.
12019
12020 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12021 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12022 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12023 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012024 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12025
12026 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12027 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012028
12029 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12030 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12031 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12032 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12033 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12034
12035 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12036 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12037 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12038 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12039 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12040
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012041 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12042 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12043
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012044 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12045 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12046 backup connections when going up.
12047
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012048 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12049
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012050 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12051 send or receive data.
12052
12053 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12054 send or receive data.
12055
12056 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12057 with nothing left in the buffers.
12058
12059 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12060
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012061 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012062 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12063
12064 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12065 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12066 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12067 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12068 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12069
12070 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12071 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12072
12073 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12074 server (HTTP only).
12075
12076 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12077
12078 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12079 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12080 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12081
12082 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12083 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12084 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12085
12086 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12087
12088 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12089 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12090
12091 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12092 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12093 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12094
12095 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12096 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012097 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12098 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012099
12100 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12101 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12102 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12103 another server.
12104
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012105 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012106 server.
12107
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012108 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12109 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12110 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12111 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12112
12113 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12114 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12115 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12116 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12117
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012118 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12119 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12120 "use-server" rule).
12121
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012122 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12123
12124 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12125 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12126
12127 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12128
12129 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12130 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12131 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12132
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012133 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12134 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012135 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012136 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12137 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12138
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012139 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12140
12141 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12142 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12143
12144 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12145
12146 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12147
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012148The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12149was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012150helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12151starvation, attacks, etc...
12152
12153The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12154alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12155easier finding and understanding.
12156
12157 Flags Reason
12158
12159 -- Normal termination.
12160
12161 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12162 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12163 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12164 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12165
12166 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12167 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12168 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12169 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12170 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12171 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012172
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012173 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12174 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012175 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012176
12177 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12178 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12179 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12180
12181 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12182 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12183 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12184 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12185 the server takes too long to respond.
12186
12187 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12188 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12189 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12190 long a time to respond.
12191
12192 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12193 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12194 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12195 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
12196 and the client.
12197
12198 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12199 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12200 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12201 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12202 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
12203 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
12204
12205 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12206 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012207 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12208 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12209 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12210 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012211
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012212 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12213 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12214
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012215 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012216 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12217 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12218 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12219 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12220 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12221
12222 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12223 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12224 503 or 504 here.
12225
12226 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12227 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12228 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12229 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12230 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12231
12232 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12233 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012234 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012235 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12236 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12237
12238 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12239 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12240 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12241 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12242 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12243 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12244 between haproxy and the server.
12245
12246 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12247 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12248 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12249 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12250 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12251 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12252 solution is to fix the application.
12253
12254 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12255 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12256 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12257 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12258 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12259 external attacks.
12260
12261 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12262 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012263 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012264 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12265 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12266
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012267 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12268 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12269 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012270 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12271 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012272
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012273 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12274 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12275 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12276 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012277 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12278 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12279 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12280 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12281 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012282
12283 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12284 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12285 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12286 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12287
12288 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12289 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12290 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12291 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12292
12293 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12294 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12295 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12296 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12297
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012298The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12299persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12300important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12301re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12302
12303 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12304
12305 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12306 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12307 set on a GET request.
12308
12309 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12310 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012311 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012312 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12313
12314 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12315 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12316 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12317
12318 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12319 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12320 already got a cookie.
12321
12322 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12323 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12324 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12325 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12326 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12327
12328 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12329 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12330 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12331
12332 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12333 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12334 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12335
12336 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12337 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12338
12339 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12340 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12341 then advertised in the response.
12342
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123448.6. Non-printable characters
12345-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012346
12347In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12348consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12349converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12350prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12351being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12352escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12353is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12354'}' when logging headers.
12355
12356Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12357issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12358containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12359
12360Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12361the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12362performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12363
12364
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123658.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12366---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012367
12368Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12369achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012370section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012371cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12372the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12373the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012374locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012375not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12376user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12377a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12378wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12379
12380 Examples :
12381 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12382 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12383
12384 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12385 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12386
12387
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123888.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12389---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012390
12391Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12392proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12393the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12394server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12395
12396Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12397response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012398section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012399
12400It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012401time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12402appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012403are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12404and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12405follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12406request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12407in the logs.
12408
12409 Example :
12410 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12411 listen proxy-out
12412 mode http
12413 option httplog
12414 option logasap
12415 log global
12416 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
12417
12418 # log the name of the virtual server
12419 capture request header Host len 20
12420
12421 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
12422 capture request header Content-Length len 10
12423
12424 # log the beginning of the referrer
12425 capture request header Referer len 20
12426
12427 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
12428 capture response header Server len 20
12429
12430 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
12431 capture response header Content-Length len 10
12432
12433 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
12434 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
12435
12436 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
12437 capture response header Via len 20
12438
12439 # log the URL location during a redirection
12440 capture response header Location len 20
12441
12442 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
12443 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
12444 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12445 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
12446 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
12447
12448 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12449 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12450 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12451 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012452 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012453
12454 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12455 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12456 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12457 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
12458 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012459 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012460
12461
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124628.9. Examples of logs
12463---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012464
12465These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
12466them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
12467reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
12468
12469 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
12470 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12471 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12472
12473 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
12474 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
12475
12476 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
12477 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
12478 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12479
12480 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
12481 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
12482
12483 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
12484 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12485 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
12486
12487 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012488 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012489 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
12490 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
12491
12492 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
12493 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
12494 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
12495
12496 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
12497 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020012498 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012499 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
12500 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
12501 to return the 502 and not the server.
12502
12503 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012504 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012505
12506 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
12507 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
12508 Nothing was sent to any server.
12509
12510 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
12511 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
12512
12513 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
12514 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
12515 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
12516 send a 408 return code to the client.
12517
12518 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
12519 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
12520
12521 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
12522 5 seconds ("c----").
12523
12524 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
12525 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012526 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012527
12528 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012529 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012530 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
12531 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
12532 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
12533 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
12534 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012535
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012536
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125379. Statistics and monitoring
12538----------------------------
12539
12540It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
12541mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
12542CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
12543Unix socket.
12544
12545
125469.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012547---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012548
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010012549The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
12550page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
12551
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012552 0. pxname: proxy name
12553 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
12554 for server)
12555 2. qcur: current queued requests
12556 3. qmax: max queued requests
12557 4. scur: current sessions
12558 5. smax: max sessions
12559 6. slim: sessions limit
12560 7. stot: total sessions
12561 8. bin: bytes in
12562 9. bout: bytes out
12563 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012564 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012565 12. ereq: request errors
12566 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012567 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012568 15. wretr: retries (warning)
12569 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010012570 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012571 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
12572 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
12573 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
12574 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
12575 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
12576 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
12577 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
12578 25. qlimit: queue limit
12579 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
12580 27. iid: unique proxy id
12581 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
12582 29. throttle: warm up status
12583 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
12584 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020012585 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020012586 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
12587 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
12588 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012589 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012590 UNK -> unknown
12591 INI -> initializing
12592 SOCKERR -> socket error
12593 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
12594 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
12595 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
12596 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
12597 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
12598 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12599 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12600 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
12601 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
12602 disable-on-404
12603 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12604 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12605 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012606 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
12607 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012608 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
12609 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
12610 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
12611 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
12612 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
12613 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012614 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
12615 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
12616 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
12617 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012618 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
12619 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010012620 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
12621 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
12622 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010012623 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreauf522f3d2014-02-10 22:22:49 +010012624 55. lastsess: number of seconds since last session assigned to server/backend
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012625
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012626
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126279.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012628-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012629
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012630The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
12631necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
12632A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
12633issuing commands by hand :
12634
12635 global
12636 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12637 stats timeout 2m
12638
12639It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
12640the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
12641never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
12642situations :
12643
12644 global
12645 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12646 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
12647 stats timeout 2m
12648
12649To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
12650swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
12651to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
12652syntaxes we'll use are the following :
12653
12654 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
12655 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
12656
12657The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
12658script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
12659for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
12660
12661The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
12662that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
12663editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
12664(eg: watch a counter).
12665
12666The socket supports two operation modes :
12667 - interactive
12668 - non-interactive
12669
12670The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
12671this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
12672sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
12673mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
12674commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
12675example :
12676
12677 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
12678
12679The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
12680entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
12681for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
12682sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
12683"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
12684after processing the last command of the same line.
12685
12686For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
12687"prompt" command :
12688
12689 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
12690 prompt
12691 > show info
12692 ...
12693 >
12694
12695Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
12696delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
12697that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
12698parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012699
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012700It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
12701on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
12702own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012703
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012704The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
12705If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
12706all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
12707it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
12708
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012709add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012710 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
12711 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
12712 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
12713 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012714
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012715add map <map> <key> <value>
12716 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
12717 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012718 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
12719 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
12720 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012721
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012722clear counters
12723 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
12724 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
12725 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
12726 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
12727 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
12728
12729clear counters all
12730 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
12731 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
12732 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
12733
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012734clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012735 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
12736 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
12737 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012738
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012739clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012740 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
12741 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
12742 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012743
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012744clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
12745 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
12746
12747 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
12748 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
12749 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
12750 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
12751 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
12752 later after the session ends is usual enough.
12753
12754 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
12755
12756 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
12757 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
12758 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
12759 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
12760 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
12761 the ACLs :
12762
12763 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
12764 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
12765 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
12766 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
12767 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
12768 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
12769
12770 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090012771 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
12772 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012773
12774 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012775 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012776 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012777 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
12778 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
12779 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12780 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012781
12782 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12783
12784 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012785 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020012786 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
12787 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090012788 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12789 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
12790 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020012791
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012792del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
12793 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012794 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
12795 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
12796 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
12797 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012798
12799del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010012800 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012801 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
12802 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
12803 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
12804 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010012805
12806disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012807 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
12808
12809 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
12810 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
12811 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
12812 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
12813 re-enabled using enable agent.
12814
12815 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
12816 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
12817 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
12818 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
12819 otherwise unchanged.
12820
12821 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
12822 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
12823 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
12824
12825 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12826 level "admin".
12827
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012828disable frontend <frontend>
12829 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
12830 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
12831 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
12832 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
12833 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
12834 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
12835 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
12836 on the stats page.
12837
12838 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12839 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12840
12841 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12842 level "admin".
12843
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012844disable server <backend>/<server>
12845 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
12846 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
12847 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
12848 during the maintenance.
12849
12850 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
12851 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
12852
12853 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012854 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012855
12856 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12857 level "admin".
12858
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090012859enable agent <backend>/<server>
12860 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
12861
12862 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
12863 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
12864
12865 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12866 level "admin".
12867
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020012868enable frontend <frontend>
12869 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
12870 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
12871 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
12872 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
12873 which was disabled.
12874
12875 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
12876 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12877
12878 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12879 level "admin".
12880
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012881enable server <backend>/<server>
12882 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
12883 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
12884
12885 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012886 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012887
12888 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
12889 level "admin".
12890
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010012891get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012892get acl <acl> <value>
12893 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
12894 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
12895 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
12896 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
12897 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010012898
12899 The first two words are:
12900
12901 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
12902 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
12903 "dom", "end" or "reg".
12904
12905 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
12906
12907 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
12908
12909 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
12910
12911 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
12912 interpretation of the case.
12913
12914 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
12915 useful with regular expressions.
12916
12917 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
12918 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
12919
12920 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
12921 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
12922 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
12923
12924 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
12925
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012926get weight <backend>/<server>
12927 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
12928 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
12929 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
12930 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
12931 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020012932 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012933
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012934help
12935 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
12936 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012937
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020012938prompt
12939 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
12940 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
12941 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
12942 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
12943 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
12944 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
12945 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
12946 command.
12947
12948quit
12949 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012950
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010012951set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010012952 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
12953 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
12954 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010012955
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012956set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020012957 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
12958 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
12959 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
12960 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
12961 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020012962 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
12963 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
12964
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020012965set maxconn global <maxconn>
12966 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
12967 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
12968 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
12969 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
12970 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
12971 setting.
12972
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020012973set rate-limit connections global <value>
12974 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
12975 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12976 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12977 is passed in number of connections per second.
12978
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012979set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
12980 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
12981 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010012982 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
12983 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010012984
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020012985set rate-limit sessions global <value>
12986 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
12987 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12988 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12989 is passed in number of sessions per second.
12990
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020012991set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
12992 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
12993 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
12994 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
12995 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
12996 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
12997
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020012998set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020012999 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13000 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13001 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13002 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013003 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13004 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013005
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013006set timeout cli <delay>
13007 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13008 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13009 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13010
13011set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13012 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13013 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013014 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13015 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13016 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13017 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13018 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13019 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13020 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13021 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13022 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13023 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13024 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13025 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13026 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013027
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013028show errors [<iid>]
13029 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13030 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013031 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13032 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13033 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013034
13035 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13036 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13037 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13038 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13039 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13040 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13041 are reported too.
13042
13043 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13044 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13045 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13046 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13047 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13048 code.
13049
13050 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13051 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13052 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13053 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13054 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13055 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13056 line.
13057
13058 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013059 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13060 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013061 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13062 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13063
13064 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13065 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13066 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13067 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13068 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13069 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13070 00204+ minal\r\n
13071 00211 \r\n
13072
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013073 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013074 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13075 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13076 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13077 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13078 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13079 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013080
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013081show info
13082 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13083
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013084show map [<map>]
13085 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013086 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13087 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13088 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13089 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13090 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13091 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013092
13093show acl [<acl>]
13094 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013095 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13096 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13097 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13098 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13099 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013100
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013101show pools
13102 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13103 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13104 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13105 the pools.
13106
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013107show sess
13108 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013109 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13110 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13111
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013112show sess <id>
13113 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13114 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13115 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13116 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13117 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010013118 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
13119 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
13120 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013121
13122show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13123 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13124 possible to dump only selected items :
13125 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13126 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13127 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13128 for example:
13129 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13130 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13131 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13132
13133 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013134 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13135 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013136 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13137 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13138 Nbproc: 1
13139 Process_num: 1
13140 (...)
13141
13142 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13143 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13144 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13145 (...)
13146 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13147
13148 $
13149
13150 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13151 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13152 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13153 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013154 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013155
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013156show table
13157 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13158 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13159 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13160 entries currently in use.
13161
13162 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013163 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013164 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13165 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013166
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013167show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013168 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13169 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13170 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013171 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13172
13173 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13174 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13175 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13176 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13177 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13178
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013179 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13180 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13181 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13182 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13183 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13184 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13185
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013186
13187 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013188 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13189 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013190
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013191 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013192 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013193 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013194 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13195 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13196 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13197 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013198
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013199 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013200 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013201 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13202 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013203
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013204 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13205 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013206 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013207 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13208 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013209
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013210 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13211 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013212 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013213 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13214 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13215
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013216 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13217 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13218 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13219 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13220 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13221
13222 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13223 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13224 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013225 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13226 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013227 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13228 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013229
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013230shutdown frontend <frontend>
13231 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13232 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13233 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13234 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13235 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13236 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13237 once it is terminated.
13238
13239 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13240 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13241
13242 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13243 level "admin".
13244
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013245shutdown session <id>
13246 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13247 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13248 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13249 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13250 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13251 flag in the logs.
13252
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020013253shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
13254 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
13255 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
13256 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
13257 'K' flag in the logs.
13258
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013259/*
13260 * Local variables:
13261 * fill-column: 79
13262 * End:
13263 */